1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ 2 /* 3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface 4 * 5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc. 6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz> 7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH 9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2023 Intel Corporation 11 */ 12 13 #ifndef MAC80211_H 14 #define MAC80211_H 15 16 #include <linux/bug.h> 17 #include <linux/kernel.h> 18 #include <linux/if_ether.h> 19 #include <linux/skbuff.h> 20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h> 21 #include <linux/lockdep.h> 22 #include <net/cfg80211.h> 23 #include <net/codel.h> 24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h> 25 #include <asm/unaligned.h> 26 27 /** 28 * DOC: Introduction 29 * 30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements 31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document 32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware 33 * drivers. 34 */ 35 36 /** 37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts 38 * 39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be 40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any 41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such 42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the 43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even 44 * tasklet function. 45 * 46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also 47 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions! 48 */ 49 50 /** 51 * DOC: Warning 52 * 53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will 54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet. 55 */ 56 57 /** 58 * DOC: Frame format 59 * 60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver, 61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are 62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the 63 * hardware. 64 * 65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features: 66 * 67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload 68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware. 69 * 70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to 71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU. 72 */ 73 74 /** 75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue 76 * 77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use. 78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by 79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the 80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback. 81 * 82 * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during 83 * suspend. 84 * 85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock. 86 * 87 */ 88 89 /** 90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing 91 * 92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the 93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between 94 * different stations/interfaces. 95 * 96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either 97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom 98 * handler. 99 * 100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with 101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and 102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames. 103 * 104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations 105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops. 106 * 107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly. 108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue 109 * driver op. 110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling 111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will 112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation. 113 * 114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to 115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to 116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls 117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using 118 * ieee80211_return_txq(). 119 * 120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has 121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling 122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq 123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls 124 * .release_buffered_frames(). 125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own 126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained 127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue). 128 */ 129 130 /** 131 * DOC: HW timestamping 132 * 133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps 134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks. 135 * 136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing 137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp 138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the 139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct. 140 * 141 * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine 142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field 143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the 144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct. 145 */ 146 struct device; 147 148 /** 149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues 150 * 151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues. 152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set 153 */ 154 enum ieee80211_max_queues { 155 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16, 156 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1, 157 }; 158 159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff 160 161 /** 162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211 163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice 164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video 165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort 166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background 167 */ 168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers { 169 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0, 170 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1, 171 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2, 172 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3, 173 }; 174 175 /** 176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration 177 * 178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS 179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29. 180 * 181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255] 182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form 183 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767] 184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min] 185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled 186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category 187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue 188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured 189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE 190 */ 191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params { 192 u16 txop; 193 u16 cw_min; 194 u16 cw_max; 195 u8 aifs; 196 bool acm; 197 bool uapsd; 198 bool mu_edca; 199 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec; 200 }; 201 202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats { 203 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount; 204 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount; 205 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount; 206 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount; 207 }; 208 209 /** 210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context 211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed 212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed 213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed 214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel, 215 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA 216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed 217 */ 218 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change { 219 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0), 220 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1), 221 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2), 222 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3), 223 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH = BIT(4), 224 }; 225 226 /** 227 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to 228 * 229 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx 230 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only. 231 * 232 * @def: the channel definition 233 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required. 234 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be 235 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions 236 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled 237 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions; 238 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static. 239 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel. 240 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 241 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information. 242 */ 243 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf { 244 struct cfg80211_chan_def def; 245 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def; 246 247 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic; 248 249 bool radar_enabled; 250 251 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 252 }; 253 254 /** 255 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode 256 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already 257 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface 258 * needs to be switched from one to the other. 259 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop 260 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but 261 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches 262 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course 263 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing 264 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context 265 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used 266 * for changes/removal.) 267 */ 268 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode { 269 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF, 270 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS, 271 }; 272 273 /** 274 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information 275 * 276 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that 277 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The 278 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be 279 * done. 280 * 281 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx 282 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching 283 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned 284 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned 285 */ 286 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch { 287 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 288 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf; 289 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx; 290 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx; 291 }; 292 293 /** 294 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags 295 * 296 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed() 297 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed. 298 * 299 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated), 300 * also implies a change in the AID. 301 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed 302 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed 303 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed 304 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed 305 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed 306 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed 307 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever 308 * reason (IBSS and managed mode) 309 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve 310 * new beacon (beaconing modes) 311 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be 312 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes) 313 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed 314 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed 315 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed. 316 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note 317 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode. 318 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface. 319 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode) 320 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode) 321 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode) 322 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface 323 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS) 324 * changed 325 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available: 326 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration. 327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed, 328 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel 329 * context had been assigned. 330 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed 331 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed 332 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected 333 * keep alive) changed. 334 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface 335 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder 336 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode). 337 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed 338 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed. 339 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed 340 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed. 341 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response 342 * status changed. 343 * @BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING: The channel puncturing bitmap changed. 344 */ 345 enum ieee80211_bss_change { 346 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0, 347 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1, 348 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2, 349 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3, 350 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4, 351 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5, 352 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6, 353 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7, 354 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8, 355 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9, 356 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10, 357 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11, 358 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12, 359 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13, 360 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14, 361 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15, 362 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16, 363 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17, 364 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18, 365 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19, 366 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20, 367 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21, 368 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22, 369 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23, 370 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24, 371 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25, 372 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26, 373 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27, 374 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28, 375 BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR = 1<<29, 376 BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY = 1<<30, 377 BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31, 378 BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING = BIT_ULL(32), 379 380 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */ 381 }; 382 383 /* 384 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number 385 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP 386 * filtering will be disabled. 387 */ 388 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4 389 390 /** 391 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver 392 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver. 393 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME 394 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received 395 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because 396 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only 397 * once each time the timeout triggers. 398 */ 399 enum ieee80211_event_type { 400 RSSI_EVENT, 401 MLME_EVENT, 402 BAR_RX_EVENT, 403 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT, 404 }; 405 406 /** 407 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT 408 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver. 409 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver. 410 */ 411 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data { 412 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH, 413 RSSI_EVENT_LOW, 414 }; 415 416 /** 417 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT 418 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data 419 */ 420 struct ieee80211_rssi_event { 421 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data; 422 }; 423 424 /** 425 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT 426 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication 427 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association 428 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received.. 429 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent. 430 */ 431 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data { 432 AUTH_EVENT, 433 ASSOC_EVENT, 434 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT, 435 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT, 436 }; 437 438 /** 439 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT 440 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully. 441 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer. 442 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out. 443 */ 444 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status { 445 MLME_SUCCESS, 446 MLME_DENIED, 447 MLME_TIMEOUT, 448 }; 449 450 /** 451 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT 452 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data 453 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status 454 * @reason: the reason code if applicable 455 */ 456 struct ieee80211_mlme_event { 457 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data; 458 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status; 459 u16 reason; 460 }; 461 462 /** 463 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events 464 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates 465 * @tid: the tid 466 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT) 467 */ 468 struct ieee80211_ba_event { 469 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 470 u16 tid; 471 u16 ssn; 472 }; 473 474 /** 475 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver 476 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type. 477 * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT 478 * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT 479 * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT 480 * @u:union holding the fields above 481 */ 482 struct ieee80211_event { 483 enum ieee80211_event_type type; 484 union { 485 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi; 486 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme; 487 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba; 488 } u; 489 }; 490 491 /** 492 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data 493 * 494 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO 495 * 496 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group 497 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group 498 */ 499 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data { 500 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN]; 501 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN]; 502 }; 503 504 /** 505 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters 506 * 507 * @lci: LCI subelement content 508 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content 509 * @lci_len: LCI data length 510 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length 511 */ 512 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params { 513 const u8 *lci; 514 const u8 *civicloc; 515 size_t lci_len; 516 size_t civicloc_len; 517 }; 518 519 /** 520 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from 521 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 522 * 523 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 524 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 525 */ 526 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery { 527 u32 min_interval; 528 u32 max_interval; 529 }; 530 531 /** 532 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters 533 * 534 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association 535 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS. 536 * 537 * @vif: reference to owning VIF 538 * @addr: (link) address used locally 539 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO 540 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE 541 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP 542 * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either 543 * ACK, BACK or both 544 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field 545 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us 546 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE 547 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed 548 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role) 549 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed 550 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role) 551 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames 552 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT 553 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection 554 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble 555 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP) 556 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing, 557 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified 558 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then. 559 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old 560 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the 561 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can 562 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after 563 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the 564 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice. 565 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf, 566 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation 567 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice. 568 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY 569 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts. 570 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync 571 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently 572 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks. 573 * Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't 574 * know how to track beacons for all of the links for this. 575 * @beacon_int: beacon interval 576 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp 577 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an 578 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in 579 * the current band. 580 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate 581 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) 582 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS 583 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not 584 * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be 585 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example. 586 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data 587 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation. 588 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel. 589 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must 590 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT. 591 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value 592 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should 593 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in 594 * relation to the newly configured threshold. 595 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value 596 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single 597 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it. 598 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold. 599 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis 600 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS. 601 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode. 602 * @txpower: TX power in dBm. INT_MIN means not configured. 603 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit 604 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular 605 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is 606 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from 607 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to 608 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace) 609 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave 610 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed 611 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS 612 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support. 613 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from 614 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated. 615 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include 616 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element. 617 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN 618 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the 619 * station. 620 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM 621 * responder functionality. 622 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder. 623 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile 624 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP 625 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set 626 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set 627 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of 628 * nontransmitted BSSIDs 629 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received 630 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set. 631 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are 632 * connected to (STA) 633 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters. 634 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE 635 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration 636 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response 637 * interval. 638 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed 639 * to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware. 640 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz 641 * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS. 642 * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env. 643 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS. 644 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT 645 * @eht_puncturing: bitmap to indicate which channels are punctured in this BSS 646 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is 647 * write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine 648 * for read access. 649 * @csa_punct_bitmap: new puncturing bitmap for channel switch 650 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability 651 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL 652 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX 653 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always 654 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be 655 * processed after it switches back to %NULL. 656 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. Internally it is 657 * write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine 658 * for read access. 659 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change. 660 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability. 661 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability. 662 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability. 663 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU 664 * beamformer 665 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU 666 * beamformee 667 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU 668 * beamformer 669 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU 670 * beamformee 671 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU 672 * beamformer 673 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU 674 * beamformee 675 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU 676 * beamformer 677 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission 678 * (non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU 679 * bandwidth 680 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU 681 * beamformer 682 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU 683 * beamformee 684 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU 685 * beamformer 686 */ 687 struct ieee80211_bss_conf { 688 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 689 690 const u8 *bssid; 691 unsigned int link_id; 692 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 693 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext; 694 bool uora_exists; 695 u8 uora_ocw_range; 696 u16 frame_time_rts_th; 697 bool he_support; 698 bool twt_requester; 699 bool twt_responder; 700 bool twt_protected; 701 bool twt_broadcast; 702 /* erp related data */ 703 bool use_cts_prot; 704 bool use_short_preamble; 705 bool use_short_slot; 706 bool enable_beacon; 707 u8 dtim_period; 708 u16 beacon_int; 709 u16 assoc_capability; 710 u64 sync_tsf; 711 u32 sync_device_ts; 712 u8 sync_dtim_count; 713 u32 basic_rates; 714 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate; 715 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 716 u16 ht_operation_mode; 717 s32 cqm_rssi_thold; 718 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst; 719 s32 cqm_rssi_low; 720 s32 cqm_rssi_high; 721 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 722 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group; 723 bool qos; 724 bool hidden_ssid; 725 int txpower; 726 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type; 727 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr; 728 bool allow_p2p_go_ps; 729 u16 max_idle_period; 730 bool protected_keep_alive; 731 bool ftm_responder; 732 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params; 733 /* Multiple BSSID data */ 734 bool nontransmitted; 735 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 736 u8 bssid_index; 737 u8 bssid_indicator; 738 bool ema_ap; 739 u8 profile_periodicity; 740 struct { 741 u32 params; 742 u16 nss_set; 743 } he_oper; 744 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; 745 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; 746 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 747 u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval; 748 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate; 749 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type; 750 struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT]; 751 u8 tx_pwr_env_num; 752 u8 pwr_reduction; 753 bool eht_support; 754 u16 eht_puncturing; 755 756 bool csa_active; 757 u16 csa_punct_bitmap; 758 759 bool mu_mimo_owner; 760 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf; 761 762 bool color_change_active; 763 u8 color_change_color; 764 765 bool ht_ldpc; 766 bool vht_ldpc; 767 bool he_ldpc; 768 bool vht_su_beamformer; 769 bool vht_su_beamformee; 770 bool vht_mu_beamformer; 771 bool vht_mu_beamformee; 772 bool he_su_beamformer; 773 bool he_su_beamformee; 774 bool he_mu_beamformer; 775 bool he_full_ul_mumimo; 776 bool eht_su_beamformer; 777 bool eht_su_beamformee; 778 bool eht_mu_beamformer; 779 }; 780 781 /** 782 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status 783 * 784 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info. 785 * 786 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame. 787 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence 788 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment 789 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the 790 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly 791 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly 792 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from 793 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing. 794 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to 795 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE 796 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for 797 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field. 798 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack 799 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination 800 * station 801 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame 802 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon 803 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU 804 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211. 805 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted 806 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to 807 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or 808 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station 809 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on 810 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for 811 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above), 812 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the 813 * hardware queue. 814 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged 815 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status 816 * is for the whole aggregation. 817 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned, 818 * so consider using block ack request (BAR). 819 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be 820 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will 821 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment) 822 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate 823 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for 824 * off-channel operation. 825 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation 826 * (header conversion) 827 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211, 828 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS 829 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211, 830 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted 831 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll 832 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must 833 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode. 834 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the 835 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used 836 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the 837 * queue gets full. 838 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted 839 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not 840 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.) 841 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME 842 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status 843 * should kick the MLME state machine. 844 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211 845 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX 846 * status to user space) 847 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame 848 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this 849 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use. 850 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on 851 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done 852 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be 853 * handled properly by the device. 854 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP 855 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow 856 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested. 857 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate. 858 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P 859 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band. 860 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period, 861 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in 862 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames 863 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for 864 * PS-Poll responses. 865 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate. 866 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when 867 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose. 868 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it 869 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for 870 * monitor injection). 871 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with 872 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without 873 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW). 874 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack 875 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK. 876 * 877 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't 878 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary. 879 */ 880 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags { 881 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0), 882 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1), 883 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2), 884 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3), 885 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4), 886 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5), 887 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6), 888 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7), 889 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8), 890 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9), 891 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10), 892 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11), 893 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12), 894 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13), 895 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP = BIT(14), 896 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15), 897 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16), 898 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17), 899 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18), 900 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19), 901 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20), 902 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21), 903 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22), 904 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24), 905 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25), 906 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26), 907 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27), 908 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28), 909 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29), 910 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30), 911 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31), 912 }; 913 914 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23 915 916 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS 917 918 /** 919 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control 920 * 921 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control 922 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP) 923 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll 924 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD). 925 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information 926 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame 927 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path 928 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup 929 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211, 930 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before 931 * it can be sent out. 932 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that 933 * has already been assigned to this frame. 934 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered 935 * relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent 936 * of their QoS TID or other priority field values. 937 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally 938 * for sequence number assignment 939 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK: Don't use rate mask for this frame 940 * which is transmitted due to scanning or offchannel TX, not in normal 941 * operation on the interface. 942 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this 943 * frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is 944 * only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is 945 * also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame 946 * is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if 947 * it's intended for an MLD. 948 * 949 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags. 950 */ 951 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags { 952 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0), 953 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1), 954 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2), 955 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3), 956 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4), 957 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5), 958 IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(6), 959 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO = BIT(7), 960 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER = BIT(8), 961 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX = BIT(9), 962 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK = BIT(10), 963 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK = 0xf0000000, 964 }; 965 966 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED 0xf 967 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC \ 968 u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \ 969 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK) 970 971 /** 972 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status 973 * 974 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid 975 * 976 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags. 977 */ 978 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags { 979 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0), 980 }; 981 982 /* 983 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are 984 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack. 985 */ 986 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \ 987 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \ 988 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \ 989 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \ 990 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \ 991 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \ 992 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \ 993 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP) 994 995 /** 996 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the 997 * Rate Control algorithm. 998 * 999 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx, 1000 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate. 1001 * 1002 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate. 1003 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required. 1004 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection. 1005 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble. 1006 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate. 1007 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split 1008 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number) 1009 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in 1010 * Greenfield mode. 1011 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz. 1012 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission 1013 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission 1014 * (80+80 isn't supported yet) 1015 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the 1016 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is 1017 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS. 1018 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate. 1019 */ 1020 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags { 1021 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0), 1022 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1), 1023 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2), 1024 1025 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */ 1026 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3), 1027 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4), 1028 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5), 1029 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6), 1030 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7), 1031 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8), 1032 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9), 1033 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10), 1034 }; 1035 1036 1037 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */ 1038 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40 1039 1040 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */ 1041 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24 1042 1043 /* maximum number of rate stages */ 1044 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4 1045 1046 /* maximum number of rate table entries */ 1047 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4 1048 1049 /** 1050 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status 1051 * 1052 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with 1053 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags) 1054 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate 1055 * 1056 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used 1057 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried. 1058 * 1059 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should 1060 * always report the rate along with the flags it used. 1061 * 1062 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs 1063 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate 1064 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example, 1065 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the 1066 * information:: 1067 * 1068 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 } 1069 * 1070 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted 1071 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four 1072 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets 1073 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status 1074 * information should then contain:: 1075 * 1076 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ... 1077 * 1078 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2 1079 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement. 1080 */ 1081 struct ieee80211_tx_rate { 1082 s8 idx; 1083 u16 count:5, 1084 flags:11; 1085 } __packed; 1086 1087 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31 1088 ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate,u8 mcs,u8 nss)1089 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate, 1090 u8 mcs, u8 nss) 1091 { 1092 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF); 1093 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7); 1094 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs; 1095 } 1096 1097 static inline u8 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1098 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate) 1099 { 1100 return rate->idx & 0xF; 1101 } 1102 1103 static inline u8 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1104 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate) 1105 { 1106 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1; 1107 } 1108 1109 /** 1110 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information 1111 * 1112 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses: 1113 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do 1114 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable) 1115 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened 1116 * 1117 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above 1118 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races), 1119 * not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which 1120 * link the frame will be transmitted on 1121 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC 1122 * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally 1123 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally 1124 * @control: union part for control data 1125 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try 1126 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS 1127 * @control.use_rts: use RTS 1128 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS 1129 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only) 1130 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table 1131 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients 1132 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL) 1133 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL) 1134 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags 1135 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs) 1136 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space 1137 * @pad: padding 1138 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates 1139 * @status: union part for status data 1140 * @status.rates: attempted rates 1141 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal 1142 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length 1143 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length 1144 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy) 1145 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only 1146 * used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness 1147 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags 1148 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area 1149 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data 1150 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK 1151 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers 1152 * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames. 1153 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set. 1154 * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames. 1155 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set. 1156 * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame 1157 */ 1158 struct ieee80211_tx_info { 1159 /* common information */ 1160 u32 flags; 1161 u32 band:3, 1162 ack_frame_id:13, 1163 hw_queue:4, 1164 tx_time_est:10; 1165 /* 2 free bits */ 1166 1167 union { 1168 struct { 1169 union { 1170 /* rate control */ 1171 struct { 1172 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[ 1173 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1174 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx; 1175 u8 use_rts:1; 1176 u8 use_cts_prot:1; 1177 u8 short_preamble:1; 1178 u8 skip_table:1; 1179 /* 2 bytes free */ 1180 }; 1181 /* only needed before rate control */ 1182 unsigned long jiffies; 1183 }; 1184 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */ 1185 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 1186 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key; 1187 u32 flags; 1188 codel_time_t enqueue_time; 1189 } control; 1190 struct { 1191 u64 cookie; 1192 } ack; 1193 struct { 1194 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1195 s32 ack_signal; 1196 u8 ampdu_ack_len; 1197 u8 ampdu_len; 1198 u8 antenna; 1199 u8 pad; 1200 u16 tx_time; 1201 u8 flags; 1202 u8 pad2; 1203 void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)]; 1204 } status; 1205 struct { 1206 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[ 1207 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES]; 1208 u8 pad[4]; 1209 1210 void *rate_driver_data[ 1211 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)]; 1212 }; 1213 void *driver_data[ 1214 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)]; 1215 }; 1216 }; 1217 1218 static inline u16 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info,u16 tx_time_est)1219 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est) 1220 { 1221 /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime 1222 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1 1223 */ 1224 info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2; 1225 return info->tx_time_est << 2; 1226 } 1227 1228 static inline u16 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1229 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 1230 { 1231 return info->tx_time_est << 2; 1232 } 1233 1234 /*** 1235 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path 1236 * 1237 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a 1238 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet. 1239 * 1240 * @rate_idx The actual used rate. 1241 * @try_count How often the rate was tried. 1242 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the 1243 * corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level 1244 * that was used when sending the packet. 1245 */ 1246 struct ieee80211_rate_status { 1247 struct rate_info rate_idx; 1248 u8 try_count; 1249 u8 tx_power_idx; 1250 }; 1251 1252 /** 1253 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control 1254 * 1255 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for 1256 * @info: Basic tx status information 1257 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver) 1258 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet 1259 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates) 1260 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver 1261 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds 1262 * Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action 1263 * frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled. 1264 */ 1265 struct ieee80211_tx_status { 1266 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 1267 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info; 1268 struct sk_buff *skb; 1269 struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates; 1270 ktime_t ack_hwtstamp; 1271 u8 n_rates; 1272 1273 struct list_head *free_list; 1274 }; 1275 1276 /** 1277 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs 1278 * 1279 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan 1280 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace 1281 * and the ones generated by mac80211. 1282 * 1283 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs. 1284 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs. 1285 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones) 1286 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies 1287 */ 1288 struct ieee80211_scan_ies { 1289 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 1290 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 1291 const u8 *common_ies; 1292 size_t common_ie_len; 1293 }; 1294 1295 IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff * skb)1296 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb) 1297 { 1298 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb; 1299 } 1300 IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff * skb)1301 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb) 1302 { 1303 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb; 1304 } 1305 1306 /** 1307 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status 1308 * 1309 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared. 1310 * 1311 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report 1312 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything 1313 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear 1314 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway). 1315 * 1316 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the 1317 * driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore 1318 * any fields it needs after calling this helper. 1319 */ 1320 static inline void ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1321 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 1322 { 1323 int i; 1324 1325 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 1326 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates)); 1327 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 1328 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates)); 1329 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8); 1330 /* clear the rate counts */ 1331 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++) 1332 info->status.rates[i].count = 0; 1333 memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates); 1334 } 1335 1336 1337 /** 1338 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags 1339 * 1340 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status. 1341 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame. 1342 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED. 1343 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware. 1344 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame, 1345 * verification has been done by the hardware. 1346 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame. 1347 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection 1348 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that. 1349 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this 1350 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection. 1351 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame 1352 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set) 1353 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did 1354 * de-duplication by itself. 1355 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on 1356 * the frame. 1357 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on 1358 * the frame. 1359 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1360 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU 1361 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS 1362 * merging. 1363 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1364 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU 1365 * (including FCS) was received. 1366 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime 1367 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received. 1368 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present. 1369 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU) 1370 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference 1371 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for 1372 * each A-MPDU 1373 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all 1374 * subframes of a single A-MPDU 1375 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU 1376 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected 1377 * on this subframe 1378 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC 1379 * is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field) 1380 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was 1381 * done by the hardware 1382 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without 1383 * processing it in any regular way. 1384 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report 1385 * them for sniffing purposes. 1386 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except 1387 * monitor interfaces. 1388 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report 1389 * them for sniffing purposes. 1390 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU 1391 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons. 1392 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g. 1393 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while 1394 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to 1395 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU 1396 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be 1397 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be 1398 * interleaved with other frames. 1399 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the 1400 * skb->data (before the 802.11 header). 1401 * If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point 1402 * to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV 1403 * data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs 1404 * in the skb. 1405 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before. 1406 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as 1407 * the first subframe. 1408 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must 1409 * be done in the hardware. 1410 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this 1411 * frame 1412 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known 1413 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present 1414 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in 1415 * 1416 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS 1417 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM 1418 * - DATA3_CODING 1419 * - DATA5_GI 1420 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC 1421 * - DATA6_NSTS 1422 * - DATA3_STBC 1423 * 1424 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data) 1425 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present 1426 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu) 1427 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present 1428 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with 1429 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is 1430 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't 1431 * known the frame shouldn't be reported. 1432 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by 1433 * hardware or driver) 1434 */ 1435 enum mac80211_rx_flags { 1436 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0), 1437 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1), 1438 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = BIT(2), 1439 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3), 1440 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4), 1441 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5), 1442 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6), 1443 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = BIT(7), 1444 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8), 1445 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9), 1446 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10), 1447 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11), 1448 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12), 1449 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13), 1450 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14), 1451 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN = BIT(15), 1452 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = BIT(16), 1453 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(17), 1454 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18), 1455 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19), 1456 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END = BIT(20), 1457 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21), 1458 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22), 1459 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23), 1460 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24), 1461 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25), 1462 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26), 1463 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27), 1464 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28), 1465 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29), 1466 RX_FLAG_8023 = BIT(30), 1467 }; 1468 1469 /** 1470 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags 1471 * 1472 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame 1473 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used 1474 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission, 1475 * if the driver fills this value it should add 1476 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT 1477 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact. 1478 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used 1479 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3 1480 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed 1481 */ 1482 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags { 1483 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0), 1484 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2), 1485 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3), 1486 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5), 1487 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6), 1488 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7), 1489 }; 1490 1491 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4 1492 1493 enum mac80211_rx_encoding { 1494 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0, 1495 RX_ENC_HT, 1496 RX_ENC_VHT, 1497 RX_ENC_HE, 1498 RX_ENC_EHT, 1499 }; 1500 1501 /** 1502 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status 1503 * 1504 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset 1505 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received 1506 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb). 1507 * 1508 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function 1509 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware. 1510 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is 1511 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache. 1512 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only 1513 * needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames. 1514 * Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled. 1515 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use 1516 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation 1517 * @band: the active band when this frame was received 1518 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz 1519 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed 1520 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting. 1521 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz. 1522 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or 1523 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags 1524 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_* 1525 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength 1526 * values were filled. 1527 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't 1528 * support dB or unspecified units) 1529 * @antenna: antenna used 1530 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if 1531 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT) 1532 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only) 1533 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\* 1534 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding 1535 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw 1536 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags 1537 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc 1538 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi 1539 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value 1540 * @eht: EHT specific rate information 1541 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc 1542 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi 1543 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211 1544 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for 1545 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU 1546 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC 1547 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU 1548 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag 1549 * is set only when connection is MLO. 1550 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with 1551 * @link_valid. 1552 */ 1553 struct ieee80211_rx_status { 1554 u64 mactime; 1555 union { 1556 u64 boottime_ns; 1557 ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp; 1558 }; 1559 u32 device_timestamp; 1560 u32 ampdu_reference; 1561 u32 flag; 1562 u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1; 1563 u8 enc_flags; 1564 u8 encoding:3, bw:4; 1565 union { 1566 struct { 1567 u8 he_ru:3; 1568 u8 he_gi:2; 1569 u8 he_dcm:1; 1570 }; 1571 struct { 1572 u8 ru:4; 1573 u8 gi:2; 1574 } eht; 1575 }; 1576 u8 rate_idx; 1577 u8 nss; 1578 u8 rx_flags; 1579 u8 band; 1580 u8 antenna; 1581 s8 signal; 1582 u8 chains; 1583 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1584 u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc; 1585 u8 zero_length_psdu_type; 1586 u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4; 1587 }; 1588 1589 static inline u32 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status * rx_status)1590 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status) 1591 { 1592 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) + 1593 (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0); 1594 } 1595 1596 /** 1597 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags 1598 * 1599 * Flags to define PHY configuration options 1600 * 1601 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this 1602 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets 1603 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags! 1604 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only). 1605 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2, 1606 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to 1607 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames. 1608 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states, 1609 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support" 1610 * for more. 1611 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set 1612 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but 1613 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will 1614 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but 1615 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active. 1616 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main 1617 * operating channel. 1618 */ 1619 enum ieee80211_conf_flags { 1620 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0), 1621 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1), 1622 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2), 1623 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3), 1624 }; 1625 1626 1627 /** 1628 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed 1629 * 1630 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed 1631 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed 1632 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed 1633 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed 1634 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed 1635 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed 1636 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed 1637 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed 1638 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used, 1639 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed. 1640 */ 1641 enum ieee80211_conf_changed { 1642 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1), 1643 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2), 1644 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3), 1645 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4), 1646 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5), 1647 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6), 1648 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7), 1649 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8), 1650 }; 1651 1652 /** 1653 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode 1654 * 1655 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic 1656 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off 1657 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static 1658 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic 1659 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use 1660 */ 1661 enum ieee80211_smps_mode { 1662 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC, 1663 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF, 1664 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC, 1665 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC, 1666 1667 /* keep last */ 1668 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES, 1669 }; 1670 1671 /** 1672 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device 1673 * 1674 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware. 1675 * 1676 * @flags: configuration flags defined above 1677 * 1678 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval 1679 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use 1680 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon 1681 * has been received and the DTIM period is known. 1682 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the 1683 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when 1684 * the CONF_PS flag is set. 1685 * 1686 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility 1687 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces 1688 * 1689 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to 1690 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled 1691 * 1692 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame 1693 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11, 1694 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries 1695 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short" 1696 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the 1697 * number of transmissions not the number of retries 1698 * 1699 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that 1700 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not 1701 * configured for an HT channel. 1702 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used, 1703 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed. 1704 */ 1705 struct ieee80211_conf { 1706 u32 flags; 1707 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout; 1708 1709 u16 listen_interval; 1710 u8 ps_dtim_period; 1711 1712 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count; 1713 1714 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1715 bool radar_enabled; 1716 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 1717 }; 1718 1719 /** 1720 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data 1721 * 1722 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch 1723 * operation. 1724 * 1725 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization 1726 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch 1727 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter 1728 * the driver passed into mac80211. 1729 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the 1730 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211. 1731 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the 1732 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP. 1733 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to 1734 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event 1735 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in 1736 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new 1737 * channel, expressed in TU. 1738 */ 1739 struct ieee80211_channel_switch { 1740 u64 timestamp; 1741 u32 device_timestamp; 1742 bool block_tx; 1743 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1744 u8 count; 1745 u32 delay; 1746 }; 1747 1748 /** 1749 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags 1750 * 1751 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering 1752 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups 1753 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality 1754 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor 1755 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and 1756 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached. 1757 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this 1758 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition, 1759 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is 1760 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces. 1761 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes 1762 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even 1763 * this is not pure P2P vif. 1764 * @IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE: disable user configuration of 1765 * SMPS mode via debugfs. 1766 */ 1767 enum ieee80211_vif_flags { 1768 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0), 1769 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1), 1770 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2), 1771 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3), 1772 IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE = BIT(4), 1773 }; 1774 1775 1776 /** 1777 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags 1778 * 1779 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled 1780 * The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211. 1781 * It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface. 1782 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload 1783 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled 1784 * The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to 1785 * mac80211. 1786 */ 1787 1788 enum ieee80211_offload_flags { 1789 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED = BIT(0), 1790 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR = BIT(1), 1791 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED = BIT(2), 1792 }; 1793 1794 /** 1795 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration 1796 * @assoc: association status 1797 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not 1798 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created 1799 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by 1800 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations. 1801 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true 1802 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002k. 1803 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in 1804 * P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002j. 1805 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The 1806 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here. 1807 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here 1808 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass. 1809 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this 1810 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list 1811 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case. 1812 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode. 1813 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid. 1814 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format). 1815 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the 1816 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what 1817 * your driver/device needs to do. 1818 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections 1819 * (station mode only) 1820 */ 1821 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg { 1822 /* association related data */ 1823 bool assoc, ibss_joined; 1824 bool ibss_creator; 1825 bool ps; 1826 u16 aid; 1827 u16 eml_cap; 1828 u16 eml_med_sync_delay; 1829 1830 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN]; 1831 int arp_addr_cnt; 1832 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 1833 size_t ssid_len; 1834 bool s1g; 1835 bool idle; 1836 u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 1837 }; 1838 1839 /** 1840 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data 1841 * 1842 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver 1843 * use during the life of a virtual interface. 1844 * 1845 * @type: type of this virtual interface 1846 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg 1847 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own 1848 * or the BSS we're associated to 1849 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration, 1850 * indexed by link ID 1851 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1852 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1853 * The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the 1854 * API calls meant for that purpose. 1855 * @dormant_links: bitmap of valid but disabled links, or 0 for non-MLO. 1856 * Must be a subset of valid_links. 1857 * @addr: address of this interface 1858 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p 1859 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively 1860 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this 1861 * vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver 1862 * can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup 1863 * for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM) 1864 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface, 1865 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added 1866 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed 1867 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field 1868 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface. 1869 * These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface, 1870 * .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver 1871 * within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change 1872 * restrictions. 1873 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC 1874 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only 1875 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per 1876 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual 1877 * monitor interface (if that is requested.) 1878 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this 1879 * interface. 1880 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211 1881 * for this interface. 1882 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 1883 * sizeof(void \*). 1884 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue 1885 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see 1886 * &enum ieee80211_offload_flags. 1887 * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled. 1888 */ 1889 struct ieee80211_vif { 1890 enum nl80211_iftype type; 1891 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg; 1892 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf; 1893 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 1894 u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links; 1895 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 1896 bool p2p; 1897 1898 u8 cab_queue; 1899 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS]; 1900 1901 struct ieee80211_txq *txq; 1902 1903 netdev_features_t netdev_features; 1904 u32 driver_flags; 1905 u32 offload_flags; 1906 1907 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS 1908 struct dentry *debugfs_dir; 1909 #endif 1910 1911 bool probe_req_reg; 1912 bool rx_mcast_action_reg; 1913 1914 struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif; 1915 1916 /* must be last */ 1917 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 1918 }; 1919 1920 /** 1921 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif 1922 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested 1923 * Return: the usable link bitmap 1924 */ ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1925 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1926 { 1927 return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links; 1928 } 1929 1930 /** 1931 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one 1932 * @vif: the vif 1933 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise. 1934 */ ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1935 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1936 { 1937 /* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */ 1938 return vif->valid_links != 0; 1939 } 1940 1941 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id) \ 1942 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++) \ 1943 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \ 1944 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \ 1945 (link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id]))) 1946 ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1947 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1948 { 1949 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH 1950 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT; 1951 #endif 1952 return false; 1953 } 1954 1955 /** 1956 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev 1957 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for 1958 * 1959 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs 1960 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev. 1961 * 1962 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't 1963 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor 1964 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.) 1965 */ 1966 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev); 1967 1968 /** 1969 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif 1970 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for 1971 * 1972 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs 1973 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif. 1974 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif. 1975 */ 1976 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 1977 1978 /** 1979 * lockdep_vif_mutex_held - for lockdep checks on link poiners 1980 * @vif: the interface to check 1981 */ lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1982 static inline bool lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 1983 { 1984 return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->mtx); 1985 } 1986 1987 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id) \ 1988 rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \ 1989 lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif)) 1990 1991 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id) \ 1992 rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \ 1993 lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif)) 1994 1995 /** 1996 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags 1997 * 1998 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver 1999 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf. 2000 * 2001 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the 2002 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this 2003 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs 2004 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC. 2005 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by 2006 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC 2007 * generation in software. 2008 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates 2009 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key. 2010 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a 2011 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames 2012 * (MFP) to be done in software. 2013 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver 2014 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV 2015 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with 2016 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does 2017 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or 2018 * MIC. 2019 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received 2020 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware 2021 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames 2022 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and 2023 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with 2024 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the 2025 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW. 2026 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the 2027 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation 2028 * only for management frames (MFP). 2029 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the 2030 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always 2031 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled. 2032 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for 2033 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with 2034 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key. 2035 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation. 2036 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver 2037 * for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number 2038 * generation only 2039 */ 2040 enum ieee80211_key_flags { 2041 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0), 2042 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1), 2043 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2), 2044 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3), 2045 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4), 2046 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5), 2047 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6), 2048 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7), 2049 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8), 2050 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9), 2051 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10), 2052 }; 2053 2054 /** 2055 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information 2056 * 2057 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by 2058 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops. 2059 * 2060 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver 2061 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be 2062 * encrypted in hardware. 2063 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector. 2064 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it 2065 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO) 2066 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags. 2067 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3) 2068 * @keylen: key material length 2069 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte) 2070 * data block: 2071 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits) 2072 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits) 2073 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits) 2074 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type 2075 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type 2076 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys 2077 */ 2078 struct ieee80211_key_conf { 2079 atomic64_t tx_pn; 2080 u32 cipher; 2081 u8 icv_len; 2082 u8 iv_len; 2083 u8 hw_key_idx; 2084 s8 keyidx; 2085 u16 flags; 2086 s8 link_id; 2087 u8 keylen; 2088 u8 key[]; 2089 }; 2090 2091 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16 2092 2093 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff)) 2094 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff)) 2095 2096 /** 2097 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter 2098 * 2099 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order 2100 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2101 * reverse order than in packet) 2102 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2103 * reverse order than in packet) 2104 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2105 * reverse order than in packet) 2106 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian, 2107 * reverse order than in packet) 2108 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys 2109 */ 2110 struct ieee80211_key_seq { 2111 union { 2112 struct { 2113 u32 iv32; 2114 u16 iv16; 2115 } tkip; 2116 struct { 2117 u8 pn[6]; 2118 } ccmp; 2119 struct { 2120 u8 pn[6]; 2121 } aes_cmac; 2122 struct { 2123 u8 pn[6]; 2124 } aes_gmac; 2125 struct { 2126 u8 pn[6]; 2127 } gcmp; 2128 struct { 2129 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN]; 2130 u8 seq_len; 2131 } hw; 2132 }; 2133 }; 2134 2135 /** 2136 * enum set_key_cmd - key command 2137 * 2138 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this 2139 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added. 2140 * 2141 * @SET_KEY: a key is set 2142 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled 2143 */ 2144 enum set_key_cmd { 2145 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY, 2146 }; 2147 2148 /** 2149 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state 2150 * 2151 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all, 2152 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions 2153 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state 2154 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated 2155 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated 2156 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X) 2157 */ 2158 enum ieee80211_sta_state { 2159 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */ 2160 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST, 2161 IEEE80211_STA_NONE, 2162 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH, 2163 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC, 2164 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED, 2165 }; 2166 2167 /** 2168 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth 2169 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz 2170 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz 2171 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz 2172 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz 2173 * (including 80+80 MHz) 2174 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz 2175 * 2176 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized 2177 * correctly, the values must be sorted. 2178 */ 2179 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth { 2180 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0, 2181 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40, 2182 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80, 2183 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160, 2184 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320, 2185 }; 2186 2187 /** 2188 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table 2189 * 2190 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update 2191 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default. 2192 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control. 2193 */ 2194 struct ieee80211_sta_rates { 2195 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2196 struct { 2197 s8 idx; 2198 u8 count; 2199 u8 count_cts; 2200 u8 count_rts; 2201 u16 flags; 2202 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE]; 2203 }; 2204 2205 /** 2206 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration 2207 * 2208 * Used to configure txpower for station. 2209 * 2210 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames 2211 * to the STA. 2212 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power 2213 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC 2214 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. 2215 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for 2216 * per peer TPC. 2217 */ 2218 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr { 2219 s16 power; 2220 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; 2221 }; 2222 2223 /** 2224 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links 2225 * 2226 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the 2227 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change. 2228 * 2229 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes. 2230 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble. 2231 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply: 2232 * 2233 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the 2234 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes. 2235 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal 2236 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes. 2237 * 2238 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level 2239 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section 2240 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2). 2241 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control. 2242 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID 2243 */ 2244 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates { 2245 u16 max_amsdu_len; 2246 2247 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len; 2248 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS]; 2249 }; 2250 2251 /** 2252 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info 2253 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single) 2254 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here. 2255 * 2256 * @sta: reference to owning STA 2257 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr 2258 * in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different 2259 * from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr) 2260 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink) 2261 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic) 2262 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates 2263 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities 2264 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities 2265 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA 2266 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities 2267 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA 2268 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation 2269 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with 2270 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the 2271 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode 2272 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after 2273 * the station moves to associated state. 2274 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration 2275 * 2276 */ 2277 struct ieee80211_link_sta { 2278 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2279 2280 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 2281 u8 link_id; 2282 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 2283 2284 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2285 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; 2286 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; 2287 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; 2288 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; 2289 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap; 2290 2291 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg; 2292 2293 u8 rx_nss; 2294 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth; 2295 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr; 2296 }; 2297 2298 /** 2299 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry 2300 * 2301 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly 2302 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in 2303 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must 2304 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly, 2305 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a 2306 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it. 2307 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association 2308 * and holds pointers to various link STA's 2309 * 2310 * @addr: MAC address 2311 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP 2312 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU 2313 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us. 2314 * Can be modified by driver. 2315 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does, 2316 * otherwise always false) 2317 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to 2318 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information. 2319 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid 2320 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in 2321 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*. 2322 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported. 2323 * @rates: rate control selection table 2324 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer 2325 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only 2326 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place. 2327 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not. 2328 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station. 2329 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single 2330 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means 2331 * unlimited. 2332 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links 2333 * For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA 2334 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it. 2335 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not. 2336 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) 2337 * is used for non-data frames 2338 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link 2339 * specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through 2340 * link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA 2341 * the first added link STA will point to deflink. 2342 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link, 2343 * i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and 2344 * would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO 2345 * STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to 2346 * @deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address 2347 * would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned 2348 * by the AP. 2349 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO 2350 */ 2351 struct ieee80211_sta { 2352 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 2353 u16 aid; 2354 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes; 2355 bool wme; 2356 u8 uapsd_queues; 2357 u8 max_sp; 2358 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates; 2359 bool tdls; 2360 bool tdls_initiator; 2361 bool mfp; 2362 bool mlo; 2363 u8 max_amsdu_subframes; 2364 2365 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur; 2366 2367 bool support_p2p_ps; 2368 2369 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1]; 2370 2371 u16 valid_links; 2372 struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink; 2373 struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 2374 2375 /* must be last */ 2376 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2377 }; 2378 2379 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP 2380 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 2381 #else lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta * pubsta)2382 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta) 2383 { 2384 return true; 2385 } 2386 #endif 2387 2388 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id) \ 2389 rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id], \ 2390 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta)) 2391 2392 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id) \ 2393 rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id], \ 2394 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta)) 2395 2396 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id) \ 2397 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++) \ 2398 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \ 2399 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \ 2400 ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id))) 2401 2402 /** 2403 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command 2404 * 2405 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this 2406 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition. 2407 * 2408 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping 2409 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up 2410 */ 2411 enum sta_notify_cmd { 2412 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE, 2413 }; 2414 2415 /** 2416 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data 2417 * 2418 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and 2419 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU. 2420 */ 2421 struct ieee80211_tx_control { 2422 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2423 }; 2424 2425 /** 2426 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue 2427 * 2428 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 2429 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue 2430 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue), 2431 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled) 2432 * @ac: the AC for this queue 2433 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size 2434 * 2435 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling 2436 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). 2437 */ 2438 struct ieee80211_txq { 2439 struct ieee80211_vif *vif; 2440 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2441 u8 tid; 2442 u8 ac; 2443 2444 /* must be last */ 2445 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2446 }; 2447 2448 /** 2449 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags 2450 * 2451 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to 2452 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning 2453 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting 2454 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule, 2455 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully. 2456 * 2457 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL: 2458 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be 2459 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm 2460 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace 2461 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control 2462 * algorithm. 2463 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of 2464 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have 2465 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config 2466 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot 2467 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for 2468 * CCK frames. 2469 * 2470 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS: 2471 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include 2472 * the FCS at the end. 2473 * 2474 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING: 2475 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames 2476 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others 2477 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used 2478 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and 2479 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that 2480 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(). 2481 * 2482 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: 2483 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We 2484 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal. 2485 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead. 2486 * 2487 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM: 2488 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from 2489 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized 2490 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set. 2491 * 2492 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT: 2493 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h 2494 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC 2495 * 2496 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION: 2497 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation. 2498 * 2499 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS: 2500 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep). 2501 * 2502 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK: 2503 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies 2504 * stack support for dynamic PS. 2505 * 2506 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS: 2507 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS. 2508 * 2509 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE: 2510 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w). 2511 * 2512 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS: 2513 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to 2514 * the stack. 2515 * 2516 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR: 2517 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including 2518 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss. 2519 * 2520 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC: 2521 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e. 2522 * dtim_period). 2523 * 2524 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports 2525 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If 2526 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not 2527 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still 2528 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag 2529 * only in that case. 2530 * 2531 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device 2532 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When 2533 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected 2534 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames. 2535 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure 2536 * the PS mode of connected stations. 2537 * 2538 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session 2539 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in 2540 * software. 2541 * 2542 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of 2543 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only 2544 * active interfaces. 2545 * 2546 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to 2547 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as 2548 * desired (and thus have them named as desired). 2549 * 2550 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the 2551 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically 2552 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if 2553 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its 2554 * supported cipher suites. 2555 * 2556 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit, 2557 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration 2558 * for frames. 2559 * 2560 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface 2561 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC) 2562 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue 2563 * control for more details. 2564 * 2565 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate 2566 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm. 2567 * 2568 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any 2569 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface 2570 * is supported. 2571 * 2572 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames 2573 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon. 2574 * 2575 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates 2576 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not 2577 * using aggregation for such frames.) 2578 * 2579 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA) 2580 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support 2581 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the 2582 * CSA frame. 2583 * 2584 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload 2585 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first. 2586 * 2587 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands 2588 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band. 2589 * 2590 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth 2591 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel. 2592 * 2593 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs 2594 * within A-MPDU. 2595 * 2596 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status 2597 * for sent beacons. 2598 * 2599 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each 2600 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified 2601 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station 2602 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time. 2603 * 2604 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the 2605 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in 2606 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session 2607 * timeout. 2608 * 2609 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX, 2610 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics. 2611 * 2612 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated 2613 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support. 2614 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must 2615 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting 2616 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta. 2617 * 2618 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list 2619 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU. 2620 * 2621 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event 2622 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such 2623 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver 2624 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout. 2625 * 2626 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself. 2627 * The stack will not do fragmentation. 2628 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well. 2629 * 2630 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on 2631 * TDLS links. 2632 * 2633 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the 2634 * mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a 2635 * deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no 2636 * beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the 2637 * virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of 2638 * the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the 2639 * deauthentication frame might not be transmitted. 2640 * 2641 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't 2642 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug. 2643 * 2644 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of 2645 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with. 2646 * 2647 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT 2648 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if 2649 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW 2650 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver. 2651 * See also the documentation for that flag. 2652 * 2653 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all 2654 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use 2655 * TXQs to start with. 2656 * 2657 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU 2658 * length in tx status information 2659 * 2660 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID 2661 * 2662 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID 2663 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set. 2664 * 2665 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only 2666 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx 2667 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID. 2668 * 2669 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation 2670 * offload 2671 * 2672 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation 2673 * offload 2674 * 2675 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx 2676 * decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface. 2677 * If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real 2678 * usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to 2679 * the stack. 2680 * 2681 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color 2682 * collision detection and doesn't need it in software. 2683 * 2684 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting 2685 * multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that. 2686 * 2687 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays 2688 */ 2689 enum ieee80211_hw_flags { 2690 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL, 2691 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS, 2692 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING, 2693 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC, 2694 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM, 2695 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC, 2696 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT, 2697 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION, 2698 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS, 2699 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK, 2700 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS, 2701 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE, 2702 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF, 2703 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF, 2704 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL, 2705 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT, 2706 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS, 2707 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR, 2708 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL, 2709 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK, 2710 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, 2711 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW, 2712 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE, 2713 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF, 2714 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY, 2715 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES, 2716 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA, 2717 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS, 2718 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS, 2719 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW, 2720 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU, 2721 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS, 2722 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR, 2723 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER, 2724 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS, 2725 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU, 2726 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST, 2727 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK, 2728 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG, 2729 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA, 2730 IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, 2731 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP, 2732 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ, 2733 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW, 2734 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ, 2735 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN, 2736 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID, 2737 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID, 2738 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT, 2739 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD, 2740 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD, 2741 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP, 2742 IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION, 2743 IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX, 2744 2745 /* keep last, obviously */ 2746 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS 2747 }; 2748 2749 /** 2750 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state 2751 * 2752 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware 2753 * information for an 802.11 PHY. 2754 * 2755 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this 2756 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev 2757 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV() 2758 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported 2759 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here. 2760 * 2761 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use. 2762 * 2763 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use 2764 * along with this structure. 2765 * 2766 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags. 2767 * 2768 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb 2769 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.) 2770 * 2771 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb. 2772 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs. 2773 * 2774 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used 2775 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB 2776 * 2777 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval 2778 * that HW supports 2779 * 2780 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for 2781 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these 2782 * queues need to have configurable access parameters. 2783 * 2784 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware. 2785 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be 2786 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw(). 2787 * 2788 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2789 * within &struct ieee80211_vif. 2790 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2791 * within &struct ieee80211_sta. 2792 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2793 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf. 2794 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area 2795 * within @struct ieee80211_txq. 2796 * 2797 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw 2798 * can handle. 2799 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages 2800 * the hw can report back. 2801 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage 2802 * 2803 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of 2804 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver 2805 * aggregation. 2806 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the 2807 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering 2808 * it shouldn't be set. 2809 * 2810 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an 2811 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll 2812 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if 2813 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N 2814 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012). 2815 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used. 2816 * 2817 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum 2818 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list. 2819 * 2820 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX 2821 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set) 2822 * 2823 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW 2824 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't 2825 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only 2826 * adding _BW is supported today. 2827 * 2828 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports, 2829 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH. 2830 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values. 2831 * 2832 * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags 2833 * 2834 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the 2835 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp 2836 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status 2837 * device_timestamp. 2838 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a 2839 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a 2840 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value. 2841 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the 2842 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set. 2843 * 2844 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created 2845 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211, 2846 * other features will be rejected during HW registration. 2847 * 2848 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate 2849 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery- 2850 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap. 2851 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means 2852 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means 2853 * neither enabled. 2854 * 2855 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may 2856 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA. 2857 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values. 2858 * 2859 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the 2860 * device. 2861 * 2862 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from 2863 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed, 2864 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers. 2865 * 2866 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while 2867 * refilling deficit of each TXQ. 2868 * 2869 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set. 2870 * 2871 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware. 2872 * The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions. 2873 * The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level. 2874 * 2875 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list. 2876 */ 2877 struct ieee80211_hw { 2878 struct ieee80211_conf conf; 2879 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2880 const char *rate_control_algorithm; 2881 void *priv; 2882 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)]; 2883 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom; 2884 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom; 2885 int vif_data_size; 2886 int sta_data_size; 2887 int chanctx_data_size; 2888 int txq_data_size; 2889 u16 queues; 2890 u16 max_listen_interval; 2891 s8 max_signal; 2892 u8 max_rates; 2893 u8 max_report_rates; 2894 u8 max_rate_tries; 2895 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes; 2896 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes; 2897 u8 max_tx_fragments; 2898 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue; 2899 u8 radiotap_mcs_details; 2900 u16 radiotap_vht_details; 2901 struct { 2902 int units_pos; 2903 s16 accuracy; 2904 } radiotap_timestamp; 2905 netdev_features_t netdev_features; 2906 u8 uapsd_queues; 2907 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len; 2908 u8 max_nan_de_entries; 2909 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift; 2910 u8 weight_multiplier; 2911 u32 max_mtu; 2912 const s8 *tx_power_levels; 2913 u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx; 2914 }; 2915 _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)2916 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 2917 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg) 2918 { 2919 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags); 2920 } 2921 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg) 2922 _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)2923 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 2924 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg) 2925 { 2926 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags); 2927 } 2928 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg) 2929 2930 /** 2931 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request 2932 * 2933 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie) 2934 * @req: cfg80211 request. 2935 */ 2936 struct ieee80211_scan_request { 2937 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies; 2938 2939 /* Keep last */ 2940 struct cfg80211_scan_request req; 2941 }; 2942 2943 /** 2944 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters 2945 * 2946 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from 2947 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request 2948 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode 2949 * @status: channel-switch response status 2950 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received 2951 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame 2952 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame 2953 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template 2954 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb 2955 */ 2956 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params { 2957 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 2958 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef; 2959 u8 action_code; 2960 u32 status; 2961 u32 timestamp; 2962 u16 switch_time; 2963 u16 switch_timeout; 2964 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb; 2965 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie; 2966 }; 2967 2968 /** 2969 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy 2970 * 2971 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query 2972 * 2973 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective 2974 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private 2975 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should 2976 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this 2977 * is already used internally by mac80211. 2978 * 2979 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy. 2980 */ 2981 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy); 2982 2983 /** 2984 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware 2985 * 2986 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for 2987 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device 2988 */ SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct device * dev)2989 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev) 2990 { 2991 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev); 2992 } 2993 2994 /** 2995 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware 2996 * 2997 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for 2998 * @addr: the address to set 2999 */ SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const u8 * addr)3000 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr) 3001 { 3002 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN); 3003 } 3004 3005 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3006 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 3007 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c) 3008 { 3009 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0)) 3010 return NULL; 3011 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx]; 3012 } 3013 3014 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3015 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 3016 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c) 3017 { 3018 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0) 3019 return NULL; 3020 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx]; 3021 } 3022 3023 static inline struct ieee80211_rate * ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c,int idx)3024 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 3025 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx) 3026 { 3027 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0) 3028 return NULL; 3029 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx]; 3030 } 3031 3032 /** 3033 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb 3034 * @hw: the hardware 3035 * @skb: the skb 3036 * 3037 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure 3038 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported. 3039 */ 3040 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb); 3041 3042 /** 3043 * ieee80211_purge_tx_queue - purge TX skb queue 3044 * @hw: the hardware 3045 * @skbs: the skbs 3046 * 3047 * Free a set of transmit skbs. Use this function when device is going to stop 3048 * but some transmit skbs without TX status are still queued. 3049 * This function does not take the list lock and the caller must hold the 3050 * relevant locks to use it. 3051 */ 3052 void ieee80211_purge_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 3053 struct sk_buff_head *skbs); 3054 3055 /** 3056 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration 3057 * 3058 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware 3059 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations. 3060 * 3061 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given 3062 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and 3063 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL 3064 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to 3065 * the station information for the peer for individual keys. 3066 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when 3067 * VLANs are configured for an access point. 3068 * 3069 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx 3070 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf 3071 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function. 3072 * 3073 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if 3074 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be 3075 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the 3076 * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range. 3077 * 3078 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is 3079 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if 3080 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the 3081 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software. 3082 * 3083 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed. 3084 * 3085 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key 3086 * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any 3087 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather 3088 * based on the receive flags. 3089 * 3090 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key 3091 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key() 3092 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate 3093 * keys. 3094 * 3095 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption 3096 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key 3097 * handler. 3098 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key. 3099 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The 3100 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did 3101 * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is 3102 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this 3103 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16. 3104 * 3105 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index 3106 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required 3107 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses). 3108 * 3109 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag 3110 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following 3111 * requirements: 3112 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211 3113 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed, 3114 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued 3115 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits), 3116 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command 3117 encrypted with the new key when also needing 3118 @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and 3119 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted. 3120 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver. 3121 */ 3122 3123 /** 3124 * DOC: Powersave support 3125 * 3126 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations. 3127 * 3128 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself, 3129 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware 3130 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode 3131 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status. 3132 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary, 3133 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required 3134 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when 3135 * it finds traffic directed to it. 3136 * 3137 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in 3138 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused 3139 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking 3140 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it 3141 * back to sleep at appropriate times. 3142 * 3143 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the 3144 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be 3145 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame. 3146 * 3147 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also 3148 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported 3149 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and 3150 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still 3151 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle 3152 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that 3153 * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that. 3154 * 3155 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the 3156 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a 3157 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to 3158 * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when 3159 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle 3160 * periods. 3161 * 3162 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling 3163 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS 3164 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally, 3165 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the 3166 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support 3167 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the 3168 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value 3169 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable 3170 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS 3171 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave. 3172 * 3173 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling 3174 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the 3175 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS 3176 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To 3177 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames 3178 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled. 3179 * 3180 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with 3181 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK. 3182 */ 3183 3184 /** 3185 * DOC: Beacon filter support 3186 * 3187 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups 3188 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that 3189 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly 3190 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the 3191 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That 3192 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information 3193 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed. 3194 * 3195 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER 3196 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support 3197 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When 3198 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the 3199 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss(). 3200 * 3201 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the 3202 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call 3203 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled 3204 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future. 3205 * 3206 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing 3207 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211 3208 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense 3209 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include 3210 * 3211 * - a list of information element IDs 3212 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element 3213 * 3214 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the 3215 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense 3216 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device 3217 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all 3218 * vendor information elements. 3219 * 3220 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information 3221 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon. 3222 * 3223 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing 3224 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing 3225 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and 3226 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136, 3227 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility 3228 * it could also include some currently unused IDs. 3229 * 3230 * 3231 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the 3232 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming 3233 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of 3234 * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when 3235 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above 3236 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be 3237 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement 3238 * them as the roaming algorithm requires. 3239 * 3240 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to 3241 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the 3242 * signal strength threshold checking. 3243 */ 3244 3245 /** 3246 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save 3247 * 3248 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve 3249 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism 3250 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009) 3251 * "11.2.3 SM power save". 3252 * 3253 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames 3254 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct 3255 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the 3256 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware 3257 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by 3258 * hardware flags. 3259 * 3260 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211 3261 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS 3262 * turned off otherwise. 3263 * 3264 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate 3265 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config() 3266 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to 3267 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP. 3268 */ 3269 3270 /** 3271 * DOC: Frame filtering 3272 * 3273 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper 3274 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when 3275 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption, 3276 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is 3277 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible. 3278 * 3279 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell 3280 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be 3281 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out. 3282 * 3283 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast() 3284 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list 3285 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces. 3286 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to 3287 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the 3288 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and 3289 * @total_flags with the new flag states. 3290 * 3291 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will 3292 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count 3293 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted 3294 * or dropped. 3295 * 3296 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared. 3297 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_ 3298 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore 3299 * the flag, but not clear it. 3300 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the 3301 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type 3302 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it). 3303 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware 3304 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes 3305 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them, 3306 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag. 3307 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well. 3308 */ 3309 3310 /** 3311 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients 3312 * 3313 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for 3314 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD. 3315 * There currently is no support for sAPSD. 3316 * 3317 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client 3318 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time. 3319 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but 3320 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies 3321 * the driver code. 3322 * 3323 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete 3324 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set, 3325 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for 3326 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames. 3327 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of 3328 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't 3329 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD. 3330 * 3331 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the 3332 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a 3333 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is, 3334 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is 3335 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this 3336 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to 3337 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will 3338 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The 3339 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its 3340 * @sta_notify callback. 3341 * 3342 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up, 3343 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period. 3344 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and 3345 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When 3346 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211 3347 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames 3348 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit 3349 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER 3350 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only 3351 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to 3352 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have 3353 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS. 3354 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is 3355 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer. 3356 * 3357 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by 3358 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them. 3359 * 3360 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi 3361 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up 3362 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being 3363 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong 3364 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be 3365 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to 3366 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can 3367 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it 3368 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames 3369 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again 3370 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked. 3371 * 3372 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any 3373 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is 3374 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any 3375 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up 3376 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when 3377 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service 3378 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called 3379 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are 3380 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting 3381 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames, 3382 * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if 3383 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames 3384 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the 3385 * buffers for those TIDs contain. 3386 * 3387 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may 3388 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must 3389 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that 3390 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid 3391 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released 3392 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp() 3393 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway. 3394 * 3395 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211 3396 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags 3397 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP) 3398 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame. 3399 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case. 3400 * 3401 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data 3402 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as 3403 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame 3404 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed. 3405 */ 3406 3407 /** 3408 * DOC: HW queue control 3409 * 3410 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static 3411 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This 3412 * was problematic for a few reasons: 3413 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames 3414 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly 3415 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames 3416 * 3417 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all 3418 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it 3419 * won't have the same problem with the software queues. 3420 * 3421 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability 3422 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do 3423 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif 3424 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will 3425 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and 3426 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors 3427 * the hardware queue. 3428 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue 3429 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.) 3430 * 3431 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual 3432 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to 3433 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a 3434 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have 3435 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios: 3436 * 3437 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3 3438 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7 3439 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8 3440 * off-channel queue: 9 3441 * 3442 * It would then set up the hardware like this: 3443 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9 3444 * 3445 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows: 3446 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0 3447 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1 3448 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2 3449 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3 3450 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 3451 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7. 3452 * 3453 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second 3454 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC. 3455 * 3456 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 3457 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the 3458 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when 3459 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode. 3460 */ 3461 3462 /** 3463 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags 3464 * 3465 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be 3466 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the 3467 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested, 3468 * but this has negative impact on power consumption. 3469 * 3470 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested 3471 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by 3472 * multicast address. 3473 * 3474 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the 3475 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them) 3476 * 3477 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set 3478 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them 3479 * 3480 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate 3481 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses 3482 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing 3483 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should 3484 * honour this flag if possible. 3485 * 3486 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this 3487 * station 3488 * 3489 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes 3490 * 3491 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames 3492 * 3493 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames 3494 * 3495 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames 3496 */ 3497 enum ieee80211_filter_flags { 3498 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1, 3499 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2, 3500 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3, 3501 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4, 3502 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5, 3503 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6, 3504 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7, 3505 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8, 3506 FIF_MCAST_ACTION = 1<<9, 3507 }; 3508 3509 /** 3510 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions 3511 * 3512 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in 3513 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed. 3514 * 3515 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation 3516 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by 3517 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer 3518 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away! 3519 * 3520 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation 3521 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation 3522 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either 3523 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or 3524 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status 3525 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after 3526 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special 3527 * status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE. 3528 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational 3529 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting 3530 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the 3531 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(). 3532 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets, 3533 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call 3534 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the 3535 * session is gone and removes the station. 3536 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped 3537 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and 3538 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers 3539 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called. 3540 */ 3541 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action { 3542 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START, 3543 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP, 3544 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START, 3545 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT, 3546 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH, 3547 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT, 3548 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL, 3549 }; 3550 3551 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1 3552 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2 3553 3554 /** 3555 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters 3556 * 3557 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action. 3558 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session 3559 * @tid: tid of the BA session 3560 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When 3561 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the 3562 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here. 3563 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the 3564 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or 3565 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL 3566 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU. 3567 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL 3568 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to 3569 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START 3570 */ 3571 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params { 3572 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action; 3573 struct ieee80211_sta *sta; 3574 u16 tid; 3575 u16 ssn; 3576 u16 buf_size; 3577 bool amsdu; 3578 u16 timeout; 3579 }; 3580 3581 /** 3582 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason 3583 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll 3584 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to 3585 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC 3586 */ 3587 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type { 3588 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL, 3589 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD, 3590 }; 3591 3592 /** 3593 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed 3594 * 3595 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit 3596 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station 3597 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40 3598 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes. 3599 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed. 3600 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer 3601 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about 3602 * the peer. 3603 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed 3604 * by the peer 3605 */ 3606 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed { 3607 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), 3608 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1), 3609 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2), 3610 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3), 3611 }; 3612 3613 /** 3614 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type 3615 * 3616 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations, 3617 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other 3618 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa). 3619 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC 3620 * operations compared to other operations/flows. 3621 * 3622 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC. 3623 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required 3624 * for sending management frames offchannel. 3625 */ 3626 enum ieee80211_roc_type { 3627 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0, 3628 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX, 3629 }; 3630 3631 /** 3632 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type 3633 * 3634 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what 3635 * reconfiguration type was completed. 3636 * 3637 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type 3638 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1) 3639 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless 3640 * of wowlan configuration) 3641 */ 3642 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type { 3643 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART, 3644 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND, 3645 }; 3646 3647 /** 3648 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information 3649 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration, 3650 * only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method. 3651 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc) 3652 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only 3653 * used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only 3654 * valid for auth and (re)assoc. 3655 */ 3656 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info { 3657 u16 duration; 3658 u16 subtype; 3659 u8 success:1; 3660 }; 3661 3662 /** 3663 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver 3664 * 3665 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may 3666 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure 3667 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame. 3668 * 3669 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame. 3670 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header. 3671 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on 3672 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should, 3673 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately. 3674 * Must be atomic. 3675 * 3676 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware 3677 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on 3678 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.) 3679 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace, 3680 * or zero. 3681 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address 3682 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device 3683 * is added. 3684 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3685 * 3686 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware 3687 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least 3688 * it must turn off frame reception.) 3689 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects 3690 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue 3691 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback. 3692 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3693 * 3694 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and 3695 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then 3696 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is 3697 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and 3698 * reconfigured at resume time. 3699 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it 3700 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only 3701 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it 3702 * must return 1 from this function. 3703 * 3704 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is 3705 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully 3706 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is 3707 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211 3708 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume. 3709 * 3710 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is 3711 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is 3712 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only 3713 * in suspend(). 3714 * 3715 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is 3716 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start 3717 * and @stop must be implemented. 3718 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before 3719 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the 3720 * interface is given in the conf parameter. 3721 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a 3722 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.) 3723 * Must be implemented and can sleep. 3724 * 3725 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback 3726 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be 3727 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep. 3728 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be 3729 * found by the interface iteration callbacks. 3730 * 3731 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down. 3732 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface 3733 * and no monitor interfaces are present. 3734 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware 3735 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets, 3736 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the 3737 * MAC address of the device going away. 3738 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep. 3739 * 3740 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this 3741 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel. 3742 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code 3743 * if it does. The callback can sleep. 3744 * 3745 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS 3746 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low 3747 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters). 3748 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless 3749 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which 3750 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback 3751 * can sleep. 3752 * Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed 3753 * are not implemented. 3754 * 3755 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface 3756 * (MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the 3757 * lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.) 3758 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed. 3759 * The callback can sleep. 3760 * 3761 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link 3762 * parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an 3763 * individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information. 3764 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id 3765 * parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for 3766 * non-MLO connections. 3767 * The callback can sleep. 3768 * 3769 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration. 3770 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed 3771 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic. 3772 * 3773 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter. 3774 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information. 3775 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep. 3776 * 3777 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter. 3778 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames 3779 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination 3780 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates 3781 * which flags are changed. 3782 * This callback can sleep. 3783 * 3784 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit 3785 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic. 3786 * 3787 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration" 3788 * This callback is only called between add_interface and 3789 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface 3790 * is enabled. 3791 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added. 3792 * The callback can sleep. 3793 * 3794 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration" 3795 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers 3796 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY. 3797 * The callback must be atomic. 3798 * 3799 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the 3800 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data 3801 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter. 3802 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify 3803 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(). 3804 * 3805 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for 3806 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP 3807 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it. 3808 * 3809 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start 3810 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel 3811 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's 3812 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure 3813 * that power save is disabled. 3814 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the 3815 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these 3816 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the 3817 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable). 3818 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called; 3819 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to 3820 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code. 3821 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1, 3822 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a 3823 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this 3824 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't 3825 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is. 3826 * The callback can sleep. 3827 * 3828 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan. 3829 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible), 3830 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call 3831 * ieee80211_scan_completed(). 3832 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new 3833 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended. 3834 * The callback can sleep. 3835 * 3836 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at 3837 * specific intervals. The driver must call the 3838 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results. 3839 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called. 3840 * 3841 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan. 3842 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called. 3843 * 3844 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan 3845 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification. 3846 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR, 3847 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it 3848 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep. 3849 * 3850 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a 3851 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need 3852 * this notification. 3853 * The callback can sleep. 3854 * 3855 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics. 3856 * Returns zero if statistics are available. 3857 * The callback can sleep. 3858 * 3859 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does 3860 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the 3861 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware. 3862 * The callback must be atomic. 3863 * 3864 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this 3865 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the 3866 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG 3867 * should be set as well. 3868 * The callback can sleep. 3869 * 3870 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it) 3871 * The callback can sleep. 3872 * 3873 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station, 3874 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep. 3875 * 3876 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated 3877 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback 3878 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected; 3879 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing 3880 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed. 3881 * This callback can sleep. 3882 * 3883 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3884 * when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within 3885 * a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep. 3886 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf 3887 * with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory. 3888 * 3889 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3890 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback 3891 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This 3892 * callback can sleep. 3893 * 3894 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files 3895 * when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback 3896 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This 3897 * callback can sleep. 3898 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the 3899 * station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory. 3900 * 3901 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an 3902 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating 3903 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag 3904 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic. 3905 * 3906 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx 3907 * power for the station. 3908 * This callback can sleep. 3909 * 3910 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a 3911 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.) 3912 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove. 3913 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions 3914 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it 3915 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace 3916 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station. 3917 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed. 3918 * The callback can sleep. 3919 * 3920 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU 3921 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station 3922 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear 3923 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse 3924 * in @sta_state. 3925 * The callback can sleep. 3926 * 3927 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be 3928 * used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits 3929 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected 3930 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver 3931 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since 3932 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly. 3933 * Must be atomic. 3934 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This 3935 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses 3936 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic. 3937 * 3938 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon 3939 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so 3940 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of 3941 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not 3942 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible. 3943 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211. 3944 * The callback can sleep. 3945 * 3946 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max), 3947 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue. 3948 * Returns a negative error code on failure. 3949 * The callback can sleep. 3950 * 3951 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently, 3952 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a 3953 * required function. 3954 * The callback can sleep. 3955 * 3956 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware. 3957 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a 3958 * required function. 3959 * The callback can sleep. 3960 * 3961 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the 3962 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between 3963 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up 3964 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function. 3965 * The callback can sleep. 3966 * 3967 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize 3968 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This 3969 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of 3970 * TSF synchronization. 3971 * The callback can sleep. 3972 * 3973 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us. 3974 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is 3975 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests. 3976 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon. 3977 * The callback can sleep. 3978 * 3979 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information 3980 * 3981 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also 3982 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration, 3983 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback. 3984 * The callback can sleep. 3985 * 3986 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified 3987 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout 3988 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout 3989 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for 3990 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep. 3991 * 3992 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may 3993 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep. 3994 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep. 3995 * 3996 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure 3997 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap 3998 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces 3999 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues. 4000 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped. 4001 * Note that vif can be NULL. 4002 * The callback can sleep. 4003 * 4004 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for 4005 * the given station, as it's about to be removed. 4006 * The callback can sleep. 4007 * 4008 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel 4009 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this 4010 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate 4011 * completion of the channel switch. 4012 * 4013 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. 4014 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may 4015 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL 4016 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). 4017 * 4018 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). 4019 * 4020 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must 4021 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note 4022 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw 4023 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted 4024 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the 4025 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call 4026 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(). 4027 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and 4028 * must be accepted in this case. 4029 * This callback may sleep. 4030 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is 4031 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep. 4032 * 4033 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes. 4034 * 4035 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes. 4036 * 4037 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware 4038 * queues before entering power save. 4039 * 4040 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection 4041 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled. 4042 * The callback can sleep. 4043 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See 4044 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types. 4045 * The callback must be atomic. 4046 * 4047 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given 4048 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for 4049 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver 4050 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD. 4051 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check 4052 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than 4053 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in 4054 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the 4055 * more-data bit must always be set. 4056 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames 4057 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set. 4058 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the 4059 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In 4060 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag 4061 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll 4062 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple 4063 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame. 4064 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be 4065 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send 4066 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for 4067 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the 4068 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP 4069 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function 4070 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP. 4071 * This callback must be atomic. 4072 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames 4073 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211 4074 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames 4075 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set 4076 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case 4077 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder 4078 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag 4079 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP 4080 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the 4081 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function. 4082 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the 4083 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set. 4084 * This callback must be atomic. 4085 * 4086 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count. 4087 * 4088 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats. 4089 * 4090 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats 4091 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets. 4092 * 4093 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association 4094 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is 4095 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated 4096 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any 4097 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's 4098 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a 4099 * management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the 4100 * driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response 4101 * and to be able to synchronize with the GO. 4102 * For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211 4103 * would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication 4104 * frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO. 4105 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return 4106 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away. 4107 * Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info 4108 * data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the 4109 * driver the duration for which the operation is requested. 4110 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep. 4111 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously 4112 * transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data 4113 * is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used. 4114 * 4115 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending 4116 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's 4117 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS 4118 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP. 4119 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS 4120 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least 4121 * 2 * (DTIM period). 4122 * The callback is optional and can sleep. 4123 * 4124 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation. 4125 * This callback may sleep. 4126 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction. 4127 * This callback may sleep. 4128 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that 4129 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same 4130 * channel context with different settings 4131 * This callback may sleep. 4132 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound 4133 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping. 4134 * This callback may sleep. 4135 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being 4136 * unbound from vif. 4137 * This callback may sleep. 4138 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to 4139 * another, as specified in the list of 4140 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according 4141 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode. 4142 * This callback may sleep. 4143 * 4144 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the 4145 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel 4146 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses 4147 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is 4148 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being 4149 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed. 4150 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface. 4151 * 4152 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and 4153 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed. 4154 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and 4155 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames). 4156 * This callback may sleep. 4157 * 4158 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed. 4159 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces. 4160 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep. 4161 * 4162 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel. 4163 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this 4164 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be 4165 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call 4166 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get() 4167 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is 4168 * 1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been 4169 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish(). 4170 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called, 4171 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway. 4172 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4173 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA 4174 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing 4175 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch. 4176 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4177 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the 4178 * driver to go back to a normal configuration. 4179 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called 4180 * when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the 4181 * driver to go back to a normal configuration. 4182 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called 4183 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with 4184 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count. 4185 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all 4186 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A 4187 * channel context is bound before this is called. 4188 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again. 4189 * 4190 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the 4191 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0 4192 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide. 4193 * 4194 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration 4195 * and hardware limits. 4196 * 4197 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver 4198 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations 4199 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The 4200 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of 4201 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation. 4202 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can 4203 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use. 4204 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both 4205 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. 4206 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or 4207 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets 4208 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue 4209 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch 4210 * response template is provided, together with the location of the 4211 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within 4212 * the function call. 4213 * 4214 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue. 4215 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a 4216 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues 4217 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action 4218 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet. 4219 * 4220 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one. 4221 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster. 4222 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf 4223 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters 4224 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config. 4225 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since 4226 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the 4227 * changed parameters. 4228 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in 4229 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of 4230 * this call. 4231 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call 4232 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with 4233 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal. 4234 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports 4235 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation 4236 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while 4237 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU. 4238 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. 4239 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. 4240 * 4241 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep) 4242 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep) 4243 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep. 4244 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer. 4245 * This callback may sleep. 4246 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags 4247 * This callback may sleep. 4248 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using 4249 * 4-address mode 4250 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings. 4251 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed 4252 * to use rx decapsulation offload 4253 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer. 4254 * This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters 4255 * are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement. 4256 * The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of 4257 * twt structure. 4258 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received 4259 * from the peer. 4260 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for 4261 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit 4262 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev. 4263 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime 4264 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected 4265 * radar channel. 4266 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to 4267 * disable background CAC/radar detection. 4268 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to 4269 * resolve a path for hardware flow offloading 4270 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while 4271 * removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer), 4272 * but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or 4273 * new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation. 4274 * The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures 4275 * that were already removed, in case they're needed. 4276 * This callback can sleep. 4277 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to 4278 * @change_vif_links. This callback can sleep. 4279 * Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links, 4280 * i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero. 4281 * In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them. 4282 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is 4283 * not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of 4284 * that. 4285 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware 4286 * flow offloading for flows originating from the vif. 4287 * Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid 4288 * at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown. 4289 */ 4290 struct ieee80211_ops { 4291 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4292 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control, 4293 struct sk_buff *skb); 4294 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4295 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4296 #ifdef CONFIG_PM 4297 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan); 4298 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4299 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled); 4300 #endif 4301 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4302 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4303 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4304 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4305 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p); 4306 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4307 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4308 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed); 4309 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4310 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4311 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info, 4312 u64 changed); 4313 void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4314 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4315 u64 changed); 4316 void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4317 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4318 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info, 4319 u64 changed); 4320 4321 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4322 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf); 4323 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4324 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf); 4325 4326 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4327 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list); 4328 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4329 unsigned int changed_flags, 4330 unsigned int *total_flags, 4331 u64 multicast); 4332 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4333 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4334 unsigned int filter_flags, 4335 unsigned int changed_flags); 4336 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4337 bool set); 4338 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd, 4339 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4340 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key); 4341 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4342 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4343 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf, 4344 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4345 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key); 4346 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4347 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4348 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); 4349 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4350 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx); 4351 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4352 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req); 4353 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4354 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4355 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4356 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4357 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req, 4358 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies); 4359 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4360 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4361 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4362 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4363 const u8 *mac_addr); 4364 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4365 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4366 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4367 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats); 4368 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4369 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 4370 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 4371 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value); 4372 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value); 4373 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4374 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4375 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4376 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4377 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS 4378 void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4379 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4380 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4381 struct dentry *dir); 4382 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4383 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4384 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4385 struct dentry *dir); 4386 void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4387 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4388 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta, 4389 struct dentry *dir); 4390 #endif 4391 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4392 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4393 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4394 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4395 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4396 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4397 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4398 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state, 4399 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state); 4400 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4401 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4402 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4403 void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4404 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4405 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4406 u32 changed); 4407 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4408 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4409 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4410 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4411 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4412 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4413 struct station_info *sinfo); 4414 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4415 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4416 unsigned int link_id, u16 ac, 4417 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params); 4418 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4419 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4420 u64 tsf); 4421 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4422 s64 offset); 4423 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4424 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4425 4426 /** 4427 * @ampdu_action: 4428 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action. 4429 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want 4430 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through 4431 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action. 4432 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver 4433 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size 4434 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the 4435 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be 4436 * possible with a buf_size of 8: 4437 * 4438 * - ``TX: 1.....7`` 4439 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1) 4440 * - ``TX: 8..1...`` 4441 * 4442 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the 4443 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be: 4444 * 4445 * - ``TX: 1 or`` 4446 * - ``TX: 18 or`` 4447 * - ``TX: 81`` 4448 * 4449 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again. 4450 * 4451 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return 4452 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START 4453 * if the session can start immediately. 4454 * 4455 * The callback can sleep. 4456 */ 4457 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4458 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4459 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params); 4460 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx, 4461 struct survey_info *survey); 4462 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4463 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class); 4464 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 4465 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4466 void *data, int len); 4467 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb, 4468 struct netlink_callback *cb, 4469 void *data, int len); 4470 #endif 4471 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4472 u32 queues, bool drop); 4473 void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4474 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4475 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4476 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4477 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4478 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); 4479 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); 4480 4481 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4482 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4483 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 4484 int duration, 4485 enum ieee80211_roc_type type); 4486 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4487 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4488 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx); 4489 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4490 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max); 4491 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4492 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4493 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); 4494 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4495 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4496 const struct ieee80211_event *event); 4497 4498 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4499 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4500 u16 tids, int num_frames, 4501 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason, 4502 bool more_data); 4503 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4504 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4505 u16 tids, int num_frames, 4506 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason, 4507 bool more_data); 4508 4509 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4510 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset); 4511 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4512 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4513 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data); 4514 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4515 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4516 u32 sset, u8 *data); 4517 4518 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4519 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4520 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info); 4521 void (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4522 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4523 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info); 4524 4525 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4526 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4527 4528 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4529 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4530 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4531 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4532 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4533 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx, 4534 u32 changed); 4535 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4536 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4537 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4538 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4539 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4540 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4541 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf, 4542 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx); 4543 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4544 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs, 4545 int n_vifs, 4546 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode); 4547 4548 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4549 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type); 4550 4551 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6) 4552 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4553 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4554 struct inet6_dev *idev); 4555 #endif 4556 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4557 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4558 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4559 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4560 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4561 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4562 4563 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4564 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4565 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4566 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4567 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4568 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4569 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch); 4570 4571 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4572 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4573 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4574 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4575 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4576 int *dbm); 4577 4578 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4579 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4580 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class, 4581 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 4582 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie); 4583 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4584 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4585 struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 4586 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4587 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4588 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params); 4589 4590 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4591 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 4592 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4593 4594 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4595 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4596 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); 4597 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4598 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4599 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4600 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4601 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes); 4602 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4603 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4604 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); 4605 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4606 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4607 u8 instance_id); 4608 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4609 struct sk_buff *head, 4610 struct sk_buff *skb); 4611 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4612 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4613 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); 4614 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4615 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4616 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4617 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4618 int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4619 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4620 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4621 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); 4622 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4623 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4624 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids); 4625 void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4626 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 4627 void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4628 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled); 4629 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4630 const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar); 4631 void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4632 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4633 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled); 4634 void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4635 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4636 struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt); 4637 void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4638 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid); 4639 int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4640 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4641 int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4642 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4643 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4644 struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx, 4645 struct net_device_path *path); 4646 int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4647 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4648 u16 old_links, u16 new_links, 4649 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]); 4650 int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4651 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4652 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4653 u16 old_links, u16 new_links); 4654 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4655 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4656 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts); 4657 int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4658 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 4659 struct net_device *dev, 4660 enum tc_setup_type type, 4661 void *type_data); 4662 }; 4663 4664 /** 4665 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device 4666 * 4667 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer 4668 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions. 4669 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by 4670 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as 4671 * @priv_data_len. 4672 * 4673 * @priv_data_len: length of private data 4674 * @ops: callbacks for this device 4675 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device. 4676 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d) 4677 * 4678 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error. 4679 */ 4680 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len, 4681 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops, 4682 const char *requested_name); 4683 4684 /** 4685 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device 4686 * 4687 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer 4688 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions. 4689 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by 4690 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as 4691 * @priv_data_len. 4692 * 4693 * @priv_data_len: length of private data 4694 * @ops: callbacks for this device 4695 * 4696 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error. 4697 */ 4698 static inline ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,const struct ieee80211_ops * ops)4699 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len, 4700 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops) 4701 { 4702 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL); 4703 } 4704 4705 /** 4706 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device 4707 * 4708 * You must call this function before any other functions in 4709 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you 4710 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information. 4711 * 4712 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw() 4713 * 4714 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise. 4715 */ 4716 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4717 4718 /** 4719 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description 4720 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec 4721 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds 4722 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period) 4723 */ 4724 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink { 4725 int throughput; 4726 int blink_time; 4727 }; 4728 4729 /** 4730 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags 4731 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio 4732 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working 4733 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one 4734 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP 4735 */ 4736 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags { 4737 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0), 4738 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1), 4739 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2), 4740 }; 4741 4742 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4743 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4744 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4745 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4746 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4747 const char * 4748 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 4749 unsigned int flags, 4750 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table, 4751 unsigned int blink_table_len); 4752 #endif 4753 /** 4754 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED 4755 * 4756 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4757 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4758 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4759 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4760 * 4761 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4762 * 4763 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4764 */ ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4765 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4766 { 4767 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4768 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw); 4769 #else 4770 return NULL; 4771 #endif 4772 } 4773 4774 /** 4775 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED 4776 * 4777 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4778 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4779 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4780 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4781 * 4782 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4783 * 4784 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4785 */ ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4786 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4787 { 4788 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4789 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw); 4790 #else 4791 return NULL; 4792 #endif 4793 } 4794 4795 /** 4796 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED 4797 * 4798 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4799 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4800 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4801 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4802 * 4803 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4804 * 4805 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4806 */ ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4807 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4808 { 4809 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4810 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw); 4811 #else 4812 return NULL; 4813 #endif 4814 } 4815 4816 /** 4817 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED 4818 * 4819 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware 4820 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device. 4821 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs) 4822 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device. 4823 * 4824 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for 4825 * 4826 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs. 4827 */ ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4828 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw) 4829 { 4830 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4831 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw); 4832 #else 4833 return NULL; 4834 #endif 4835 } 4836 4837 /** 4838 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger 4839 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for 4840 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags 4841 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput 4842 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table 4843 * 4844 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are 4845 * configured) or the name of the new trigger. 4846 * 4847 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw(). 4848 */ 4849 static inline const char * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,unsigned int flags,const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink * blink_table,unsigned int blink_table_len)4850 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags, 4851 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table, 4852 unsigned int blink_table_len) 4853 { 4854 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS 4855 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table, 4856 blink_table_len); 4857 #else 4858 return NULL; 4859 #endif 4860 } 4861 4862 /** 4863 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device 4864 * 4865 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources 4866 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem. 4867 * 4868 * @hw: the hardware to unregister 4869 */ 4870 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4871 4872 /** 4873 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor 4874 * 4875 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the 4876 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw() 4877 * before calling this function. 4878 * 4879 * @hw: the hardware to free 4880 */ 4881 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4882 4883 /** 4884 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely 4885 * 4886 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason 4887 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state 4888 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware 4889 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by 4890 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all 4891 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function. 4892 * 4893 * @hw: the hardware to restart 4894 */ 4895 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 4896 4897 /** 4898 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list 4899 * 4900 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4901 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4902 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4903 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4904 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4905 * 4906 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4907 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4908 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 4909 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4910 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4911 * 4912 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock 4913 * 4914 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4915 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL 4916 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4917 * @list: the destination list 4918 */ 4919 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4920 struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list); 4921 4922 /** 4923 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context 4924 * 4925 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4926 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4927 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4928 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4929 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4930 * 4931 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4932 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4933 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 4934 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4935 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4936 * 4937 * This function must be called with BHs disabled. 4938 * 4939 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4940 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL 4941 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4942 * @napi: the NAPI context 4943 */ 4944 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 4945 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi); 4946 4947 /** 4948 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame 4949 * 4950 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive 4951 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a 4952 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211 4953 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory 4954 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack. 4955 * 4956 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 4957 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to 4958 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be 4959 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4960 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4961 * 4962 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni(). 4963 * 4964 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4965 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4966 */ ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)4967 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb) 4968 { 4969 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL); 4970 } 4971 4972 /** 4973 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame 4974 * 4975 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context 4976 * (internally defers to a tasklet.) 4977 * 4978 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not 4979 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with 4980 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4981 * 4982 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4983 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4984 */ 4985 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb); 4986 4987 /** 4988 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context) 4989 * 4990 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context 4991 * (internally disables bottom halves). 4992 * 4993 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may 4994 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 4995 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni(). 4996 * 4997 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on 4998 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call 4999 */ ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5000 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5001 struct sk_buff *skb) 5002 { 5003 local_bh_disable(); 5004 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb); 5005 local_bh_enable(); 5006 } 5007 5008 /** 5009 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta 5010 * 5011 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS 5012 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station 5013 * entering/leaving PS mode. 5014 * 5015 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled. 5016 * 5017 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against 5018 * each other. 5019 * 5020 * @sta: currently connected sta 5021 * @start: start or stop PS 5022 * 5023 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set. 5024 */ 5025 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start); 5026 5027 /** 5028 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta 5029 * (in process context) 5030 * 5031 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context 5032 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still 5033 * applies. 5034 * 5035 * @sta: currently connected sta 5036 * @start: start or stop PS 5037 * 5038 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(). 5039 */ ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,bool start)5040 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5041 bool start) 5042 { 5043 int ret; 5044 5045 local_bh_disable(); 5046 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start); 5047 local_bh_enable(); 5048 5049 return ret; 5050 } 5051 5052 /** 5053 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received 5054 * @sta: currently connected station 5055 * 5056 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set, 5057 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a 5058 * connected station was received. 5059 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() 5060 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must 5061 * be serialized. 5062 */ 5063 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta); 5064 5065 /** 5066 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received 5067 * @sta: currently connected station 5068 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame 5069 * 5070 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set, 5071 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame 5072 * from a connected station was received. 5073 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() 5074 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be 5075 * serialized. 5076 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown. 5077 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC 5078 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper 5079 * checks. 5080 */ 5081 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 5082 5083 /* 5084 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions. 5085 * This is enough for the radiotap header. 5086 */ 5087 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4) 5088 5089 /** 5090 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames 5091 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station 5092 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames 5093 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID 5094 * 5095 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing 5096 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need 5097 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit. 5098 * 5099 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are 5100 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data 5101 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim 5102 * call! Beware of the locking!) 5103 * 5104 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD) 5105 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are 5106 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes 5107 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data, 5108 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered 5109 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP). 5110 * 5111 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per 5112 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since 5113 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the 5114 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that 5115 * use this API. 5116 */ 5117 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5118 u8 tid, bool buffered); 5119 5120 /** 5121 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet 5122 * 5123 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support 5124 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent 5125 * rate selection table for the station entry. 5126 * 5127 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5128 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent. 5129 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted. 5130 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information 5131 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch 5132 */ 5133 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5134 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5135 struct sk_buff *skb, 5136 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest, 5137 int max_rates); 5138 5139 /** 5140 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station 5141 * 5142 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput 5143 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can 5144 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station 5145 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic 5146 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause 5147 * slow stations to starve). 5148 * 5149 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for. 5150 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps. 5151 */ 5152 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 5153 u32 thr); 5154 5155 /** 5156 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback 5157 * 5158 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta 5159 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision 5160 * in updating the tx rate in data path. 5161 * 5162 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5163 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for. 5164 * @info: tx status information 5165 */ 5166 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5167 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 5168 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info); 5169 5170 /** 5171 * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback 5172 * 5173 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been 5174 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for 5175 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics. 5176 * 5177 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function 5178 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls 5179 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() 5180 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with 5181 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni(). 5182 * 5183 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5184 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5185 */ 5186 void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5187 struct sk_buff *skb); 5188 5189 /** 5190 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback 5191 * 5192 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status 5193 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not 5194 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info. 5195 * 5196 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized 5197 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() 5198 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5199 * 5200 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5201 * @status: tx status information 5202 */ 5203 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5204 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status); 5205 5206 /** 5207 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb 5208 * 5209 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status 5210 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to 5211 * specific skbs. 5212 * 5213 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized 5214 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() 5215 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5216 * 5217 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5218 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent 5219 * (NULL for multicast packets) 5220 * @info: tx status information 5221 */ ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_sta * sta,struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)5222 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5223 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 5224 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info) 5225 { 5226 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = { 5227 .sta = sta, 5228 .info = info, 5229 }; 5230 5231 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status); 5232 } 5233 5234 /** 5235 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context) 5236 * 5237 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context. 5238 * 5239 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and 5240 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed 5241 * for a single hardware. 5242 * 5243 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5244 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5245 */ ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5246 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5247 struct sk_buff *skb) 5248 { 5249 local_bh_disable(); 5250 ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb); 5251 local_bh_enable(); 5252 } 5253 5254 /** 5255 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback 5256 * 5257 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context 5258 * (internally defers to a tasklet.) 5259 * 5260 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and 5261 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware. 5262 * 5263 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by 5264 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call 5265 */ 5266 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5267 struct sk_buff *skb); 5268 5269 /** 5270 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station 5271 * 5272 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding 5273 * connected STA. 5274 * 5275 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta 5276 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response 5277 */ 5278 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets); 5279 5280 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2 5281 5282 /** 5283 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets 5284 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element 5285 * @tim_length: size of TIM element 5286 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets 5287 * to countdown counters. This array can contain zero values which 5288 * should be ignored. 5289 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element 5290 */ 5291 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets { 5292 u16 tim_offset; 5293 u16 tim_length; 5294 5295 u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM]; 5296 u16 mbssid_off; 5297 }; 5298 5299 /** 5300 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function 5301 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5302 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5303 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will 5304 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. 5305 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA 5306 * that is not associated with AP MLD). 5307 * 5308 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to 5309 * obtain the beacon template. 5310 * 5311 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the 5312 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template 5313 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when 5314 * applicable, the CSA count. 5315 * 5316 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 5317 * 5318 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error. 5319 */ 5320 struct sk_buff * 5321 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5322 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5323 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs, 5324 unsigned int link_id); 5325 5326 /** 5327 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation 5328 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5329 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5330 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will 5331 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. 5332 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP). 5333 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set. 5334 * 5335 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template() 5336 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the 5337 * requested index. 5338 * 5339 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates. 5340 */ 5341 struct sk_buff * 5342 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5343 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5344 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs, 5345 unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index); 5346 5347 /** 5348 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons 5349 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons. 5350 * 5351 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons. 5352 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon 5353 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will 5354 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver. 5355 */ 5356 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons { 5357 u8 cnt; 5358 struct { 5359 struct sk_buff *skb; 5360 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs; 5361 } bcn[]; 5362 }; 5363 5364 /** 5365 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation 5366 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5367 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5368 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP) 5369 * 5370 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template() 5371 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required 5372 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only 5373 * one multiple BSSID element. 5374 * 5375 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory. 5376 * 5377 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *. 5378 * %NULL on error. 5379 */ 5380 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons * 5381 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5382 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5383 unsigned int link_id); 5384 5385 /** 5386 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list 5387 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers. 5388 * 5389 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling 5390 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list() 5391 */ 5392 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons); 5393 5394 /** 5395 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function 5396 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5397 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5398 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset. 5399 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes). 5400 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length, 5401 * (including the ID and length bytes!). 5402 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes). 5403 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA 5404 * that is not associated with AP MLD). 5405 * 5406 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to 5407 * obtain the beacon frame. 5408 * 5409 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5410 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon 5411 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly 5412 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt). 5413 * 5414 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 5415 * 5416 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error. 5417 */ 5418 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5419 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5420 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length, 5421 unsigned int link_id); 5422 5423 /** 5424 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function 5425 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5426 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5427 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA 5428 * that is not associated with AP MLD). 5429 * 5430 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(). 5431 * 5432 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(). 5433 */ ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)5434 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5435 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5436 unsigned int link_id) 5437 { 5438 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id); 5439 } 5440 5441 /** 5442 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown 5443 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5444 * 5445 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission. 5446 * This function is called implicitly when 5447 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the 5448 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this 5449 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown. 5450 * 5451 * Return: new countdown value 5452 */ 5453 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5454 5455 /** 5456 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown 5457 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5458 * @counter: the new value for the counter 5459 * 5460 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be 5461 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211. 5462 * 5463 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(), 5464 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value. 5465 */ 5466 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter); 5467 5468 /** 5469 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch 5470 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5471 * 5472 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this 5473 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to 5474 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed. 5475 */ 5476 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5477 5478 /** 5479 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1 5480 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5481 * 5482 * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero. 5483 */ 5484 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5485 5486 /** 5487 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change 5488 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5489 * 5490 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this 5491 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to 5492 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed 5493 */ 5494 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5495 5496 /** 5497 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template 5498 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5499 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5500 * 5501 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to 5502 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller. 5503 * 5504 * Can only be called in AP mode. 5505 * 5506 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error. 5507 */ 5508 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5509 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5510 5511 /** 5512 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template 5513 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5514 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5515 * 5516 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to 5517 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct 5518 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used. 5519 * 5520 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the 5521 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit. 5522 * 5523 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error. 5524 */ 5525 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5526 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5527 5528 /** 5529 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template 5530 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5531 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5532 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses 5533 * for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with 5534 * MLD addresses, however useful that might be. 5535 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set 5536 * if at all possible 5537 * 5538 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to 5539 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct 5540 * BSSID and address is used. 5541 * 5542 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the 5543 * returned packet will be QoS NDP. 5544 * 5545 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the 5546 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields. 5547 * 5548 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error. 5549 */ 5550 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5551 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5552 int link_id, bool qos_ok); 5553 5554 /** 5555 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template 5556 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5557 * @src_addr: source MAC address 5558 * @ssid: SSID buffer 5559 * @ssid_len: length of SSID 5560 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs 5561 * 5562 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to 5563 * hardware. 5564 * 5565 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error. 5566 */ 5567 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5568 const u8 *src_addr, 5569 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, 5570 size_t tailroom); 5571 5572 /** 5573 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function 5574 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5575 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5576 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS. 5577 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets). 5578 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5579 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame. 5580 * 5581 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5582 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5583 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible 5584 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed. 5585 */ 5586 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5587 const void *frame, size_t frame_len, 5588 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl, 5589 struct ieee80211_rts *rts); 5590 5591 /** 5592 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame 5593 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5594 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5595 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS. 5596 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5597 * 5598 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide 5599 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5600 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder. 5601 * 5602 * Return: The duration. 5603 */ 5604 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5605 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len, 5606 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl); 5607 5608 /** 5609 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function 5610 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5611 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5612 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self. 5613 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets). 5614 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5615 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame. 5616 * 5617 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in 5618 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5619 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible 5620 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed. 5621 */ 5622 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5623 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5624 const void *frame, size_t frame_len, 5625 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl, 5626 struct ieee80211_cts *cts); 5627 5628 /** 5629 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame 5630 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5631 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5632 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self. 5633 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 5634 * 5635 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide 5636 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive 5637 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder. 5638 * 5639 * Return: The duration. 5640 */ 5641 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5642 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5643 size_t frame_len, 5644 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl); 5645 5646 /** 5647 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame 5648 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5649 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5650 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on 5651 * @frame_len: the length of the frame. 5652 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted. 5653 * 5654 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its 5655 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps). 5656 * 5657 * Return: The duration. 5658 */ 5659 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5660 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5661 enum nl80211_band band, 5662 size_t frame_len, 5663 struct ieee80211_rate *rate); 5664 5665 /** 5666 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames 5667 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5668 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 5669 * 5670 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If 5671 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast 5672 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host 5673 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered 5674 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame. 5675 * 5676 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered 5677 * frames are available. 5678 * 5679 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was 5680 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus 5681 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns 5682 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver 5683 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to 5684 * use common code for all beacons. 5685 */ 5686 struct sk_buff * 5687 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 5688 5689 /** 5690 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32 5691 * 5692 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32. 5693 * 5694 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5695 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for 5696 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5697 */ 5698 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5699 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k); 5700 5701 /** 5702 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key 5703 * 5704 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken 5705 * from the given packet. 5706 * 5707 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5708 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted 5709 * with this P1K 5710 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5711 */ ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf * keyconf,struct sk_buff * skb,u16 * p1k)5712 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5713 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k) 5714 { 5715 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data; 5716 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control); 5717 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]); 5718 5719 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k); 5720 } 5721 5722 /** 5723 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX 5724 * 5725 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32 5726 * and transmitter address. 5727 * 5728 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5729 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key 5730 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for 5731 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values 5732 */ 5733 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5734 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k); 5735 5736 /** 5737 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key 5738 * 5739 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values 5740 * in the packet. 5741 * 5742 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5743 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be 5744 * encrypted with this key 5745 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes 5746 */ 5747 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5748 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k); 5749 5750 /** 5751 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos 5752 * 5753 * @pos: start of crypto header 5754 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5755 * @pn: PN to add 5756 * 5757 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of 5758 * the packet payload) 5759 * 5760 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should 5761 * point to the crypto header) 5762 */ 5763 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn); 5764 5765 /** 5766 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter 5767 * 5768 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5769 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only); 5770 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For 5771 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid. 5772 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data 5773 * 5774 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs 5775 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done 5776 * by the device and not by mac80211. 5777 * 5778 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing 5779 * can be done concurrently. 5780 */ 5781 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5782 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 5783 5784 /** 5785 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter 5786 * 5787 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5788 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only); 5789 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For 5790 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid. 5791 * @seq: new sequence data 5792 * 5793 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the 5794 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK 5795 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called 5796 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211. 5797 * 5798 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing 5799 * can be done concurrently. 5800 */ 5801 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, 5802 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq); 5803 5804 /** 5805 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key 5806 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key 5807 * 5808 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the 5809 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but 5810 * instead assumed to have been removed already. 5811 * 5812 * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently) 5813 * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().) 5814 */ 5815 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5816 5817 /** 5818 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN 5819 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on 5820 * @keyconf: new key data 5821 * 5822 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new 5823 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper 5824 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them. 5825 * 5826 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will 5827 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to 5828 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an 5829 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc. 5830 * 5831 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware 5832 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK 5833 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver 5834 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses 5835 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part 5836 * of the reconfiguration. 5837 * 5838 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq() 5839 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly. 5840 * 5841 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware, 5842 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases 5843 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for 5844 * the key that's being replaced. 5845 */ 5846 struct ieee80211_key_conf * 5847 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 5848 struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5849 5850 /** 5851 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying 5852 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on 5853 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association 5854 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying 5855 * @gfp: allocation flags 5856 */ 5857 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid, 5858 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); 5859 5860 /** 5861 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key 5862 * 5863 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called 5864 * at the same time. 5865 * 5866 * @keyconf: the key in question 5867 */ 5868 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5869 5870 /** 5871 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key 5872 * 5873 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called 5874 * at the same time. 5875 * 5876 * @keyconf: the key in question 5877 */ 5878 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf); 5879 5880 /** 5881 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue 5882 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5883 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5884 * 5885 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue. 5886 */ 5887 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5888 5889 /** 5890 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue 5891 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5892 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5893 * 5894 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue. 5895 */ 5896 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5897 5898 /** 5899 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue 5900 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5901 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero). 5902 * 5903 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped. 5904 * 5905 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise. 5906 */ 5907 5908 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue); 5909 5910 /** 5911 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues 5912 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5913 * 5914 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues. 5915 */ 5916 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5917 5918 /** 5919 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues 5920 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 5921 * 5922 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues. 5923 */ 5924 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5925 5926 /** 5927 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan 5928 * 5929 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is 5930 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify 5931 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from 5932 * any context, including hardirq context. 5933 * 5934 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan 5935 * @info: information about the completed scan 5936 */ 5937 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 5938 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); 5939 5940 /** 5941 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan 5942 * 5943 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the 5944 * driver whenever there are new scan results available. 5945 * 5946 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans 5947 */ 5948 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5949 5950 /** 5951 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped 5952 * 5953 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by 5954 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task. 5955 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan 5956 * while associating, for instance. 5957 * 5958 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans 5959 */ 5960 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 5961 5962 /** 5963 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags 5964 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have 5965 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware 5966 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new 5967 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they 5968 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet. 5969 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all 5970 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet. 5971 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up). 5972 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA 5973 * is not in the driver. This may fix crashes during firmware recovery 5974 * for instance. 5975 */ 5976 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags { 5977 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0, 5978 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0), 5979 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1), 5980 IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER = BIT(2), 5981 }; 5982 5983 /** 5984 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces 5985 * 5986 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 5987 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as 5988 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep. 5989 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 5990 * 5991 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 5992 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 5993 * @iterator: the iterator function to call 5994 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 5995 */ 5996 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags, 5997 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac, 5998 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 5999 void *data); 6000 6001 /** 6002 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces 6003 * 6004 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 6005 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 6006 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator 6007 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can 6008 * be used. 6009 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 6010 * 6011 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6012 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 6013 * @iterator: the iterator function to call 6014 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6015 */ 6016 static inline void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)6017 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags, 6018 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac, 6019 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 6020 void *data) 6021 { 6022 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw, 6023 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE, 6024 iterator, data); 6025 } 6026 6027 /** 6028 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces 6029 * 6030 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 6031 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 6032 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic, 6033 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead. 6034 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface(). 6035 * 6036 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6037 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 6038 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 6039 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6040 */ 6041 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6042 u32 iter_flags, 6043 void (*iterator)(void *data, 6044 u8 *mac, 6045 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 6046 void *data); 6047 6048 /** 6049 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces 6050 * 6051 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given 6052 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them. 6053 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex. 6054 * 6055 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6056 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags 6057 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 6058 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6059 */ 6060 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6061 u32 iter_flags, 6062 void (*iterator)(void *data, 6063 u8 *mac, 6064 struct ieee80211_vif *vif), 6065 void *data); 6066 6067 /** 6068 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations 6069 * 6070 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given 6071 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback 6072 * function for them. 6073 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic, 6074 * 6075 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6076 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep 6077 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6078 */ 6079 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6080 void (*iterator)(void *data, 6081 struct ieee80211_sta *sta), 6082 void *data); 6083 6084 /** 6085 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx - iterate stations 6086 * 6087 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given 6088 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback 6089 * function for them. This version can only be used while holding the wiphy 6090 * mutex. 6091 * 6092 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over 6093 * @iterator: the iterator function to call 6094 * @data: first argument of the iterator function 6095 */ 6096 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6097 void (*iterator)(void *data, 6098 struct ieee80211_sta *sta), 6099 void *data); 6100 6101 /** 6102 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue 6103 * 6104 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue. 6105 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be. 6106 * 6107 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for 6108 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue 6109 */ 6110 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work); 6111 6112 /** 6113 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue 6114 * 6115 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211 6116 * workqueue. 6117 * 6118 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for 6119 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue 6120 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing 6121 */ 6122 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6123 struct delayed_work *dwork, 6124 unsigned long delay); 6125 6126 /** 6127 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer. 6128 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session 6129 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 6130 * 6131 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer 6132 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the 6133 * mac80211. 6134 * 6135 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section. 6136 */ 6137 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6138 u16 tid); 6139 6140 /** 6141 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session. 6142 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session 6143 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 6144 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs) 6145 * 6146 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise 6147 * 6148 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate 6149 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level 6150 * will be managed by the mac80211. 6151 */ 6152 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid, 6153 u16 timeout); 6154 6155 /** 6156 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate. 6157 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6158 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient. 6159 * @tid: the TID to BA on. 6160 * 6161 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has 6162 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called 6163 * from any context. 6164 */ 6165 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra, 6166 u16 tid); 6167 6168 /** 6169 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session. 6170 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop 6171 * @tid: the TID to stop BA. 6172 * 6173 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active 6174 * 6175 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate 6176 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level 6177 * will be managed by the mac80211. 6178 */ 6179 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid); 6180 6181 /** 6182 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate. 6183 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6184 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient. 6185 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on. 6186 * 6187 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has 6188 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It 6189 * can be called from any context. 6190 */ 6191 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra, 6192 u16 tid); 6193 6194 /** 6195 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station 6196 * 6197 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on 6198 * @addr: station's address 6199 * 6200 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise. 6201 * 6202 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the 6203 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well. 6204 */ 6205 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6206 const u8 *addr); 6207 6208 /** 6209 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware 6210 * 6211 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6212 * @addr: remote station's address 6213 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'. 6214 * 6215 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise. 6216 * 6217 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the 6218 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well. 6219 * 6220 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get 6221 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'. 6222 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple 6223 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another 6224 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first). 6225 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL 6226 * is not reliable. 6227 * 6228 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible. 6229 */ 6230 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6231 const u8 *addr, 6232 const u8 *localaddr); 6233 6234 /** 6235 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses 6236 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6237 * @addr: remote station's link address 6238 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that) 6239 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found, 6240 * may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed 6241 * 6242 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection. 6243 */ 6244 struct ieee80211_sta * 6245 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6246 const u8 *addr, 6247 const u8 *localaddr, 6248 unsigned int *link_id); 6249 6250 /** 6251 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up 6252 * @hw: the hardware 6253 * @pubsta: the station 6254 * @block: whether to block or unblock 6255 * 6256 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues 6257 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before 6258 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be 6259 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected 6260 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag. 6261 * 6262 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free 6263 * manner. 6264 * 6265 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames 6266 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not 6267 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call 6268 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to 6269 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the 6270 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must 6271 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will 6272 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if 6273 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also 6274 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver 6275 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after 6276 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually 6277 * woke up while blocked or not. 6278 */ 6279 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6280 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block); 6281 6282 /** 6283 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP 6284 * @pubsta: the station 6285 * 6286 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell 6287 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the 6288 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead. 6289 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD. 6290 * 6291 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must 6292 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function 6293 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or 6294 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix! 6295 * 6296 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no 6297 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if 6298 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history 6299 * and restore the _irqsafe version! 6300 */ 6301 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 6302 6303 /** 6304 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP 6305 * @pubsta: the station 6306 * @tid: the tid of the NDP 6307 * 6308 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close 6309 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when 6310 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window. 6311 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a 6312 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the 6313 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to 6314 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any 6315 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong. 6316 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame 6317 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save. 6318 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames(). 6319 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver 6320 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call 6321 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent. 6322 */ 6323 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid); 6324 6325 /** 6326 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change 6327 * @pubsta: the station 6328 * 6329 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in 6330 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of 6331 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta. 6332 * 6333 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case 6334 * there is no need to call this function. 6335 */ 6336 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta); 6337 6338 /** 6339 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid 6340 * 6341 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call 6342 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of 6343 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule 6344 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness. 6345 * 6346 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent 6347 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not 6348 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the 6349 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame 6350 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission 6351 * attempts. 6352 * 6353 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or 6354 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available. 6355 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of 6356 * them to 0. 6357 * 6358 * @pubsta: the station 6359 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for 6360 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec) 6361 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec) 6362 */ 6363 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid, 6364 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime); 6365 6366 /** 6367 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device 6368 * 6369 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6370 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 6371 * 6372 * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can 6373 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false. 6374 */ 6375 bool 6376 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 6377 6378 /** 6379 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device 6380 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6381 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all 6382 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key 6383 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function 6384 * 6385 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to 6386 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into 6387 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device 6388 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due 6389 * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few 6390 * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep. 6391 * 6392 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order 6393 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the 6394 * set_key callback. 6395 */ 6396 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6397 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6398 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6399 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6400 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6401 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 6402 void *data), 6403 void *iter_data); 6404 6405 /** 6406 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device 6407 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6408 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all 6409 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key 6410 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function 6411 * 6412 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to 6413 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into 6414 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station 6415 * in removal process will be skipped. 6416 * 6417 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section, 6418 * and thus iter must be atomic. 6419 */ 6420 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6421 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6422 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6423 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6424 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6425 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key, 6426 void *data), 6427 void *iter_data); 6428 6429 /** 6430 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts 6431 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 6432 * @iter: iterator function 6433 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function 6434 * 6435 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and 6436 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other 6437 * places while calling into the driver. 6438 * 6439 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during 6440 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being 6441 * removed. 6442 * 6443 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed 6444 * before the restart are considered already present so will be 6445 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already 6446 * or not. 6447 */ 6448 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic( 6449 struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6450 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6451 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf, 6452 void *data), 6453 void *iter_data); 6454 6455 /** 6456 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template 6457 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 6458 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6459 * 6460 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to 6461 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate 6462 * information. This function must only be called from within the 6463 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function 6464 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return 6465 * %NULL. 6466 * 6467 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error. 6468 */ 6469 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6470 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6471 6472 /** 6473 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons 6474 * 6475 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6476 * 6477 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and 6478 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the 6479 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function. 6480 */ 6481 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6482 6483 /** 6484 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP 6485 * 6486 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6487 * 6488 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and 6489 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver 6490 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost. 6491 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated 6492 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set. 6493 * 6494 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state, 6495 * without connection recovery attempts. 6496 */ 6497 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6498 6499 /** 6500 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection 6501 * 6502 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6503 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired 6504 * 6505 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a 6506 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired. 6507 */ 6508 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect); 6509 6510 /** 6511 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume 6512 * 6513 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6514 * 6515 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume. 6516 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the 6517 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were 6518 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or 6519 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume. 6520 * 6521 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses 6522 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface 6523 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then 6524 * disconnect normally later. 6525 * 6526 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and 6527 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it 6528 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the 6529 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto). 6530 */ 6531 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6532 6533 /** 6534 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after 6535 * hardware restart 6536 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6537 * 6538 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after 6539 * hardware restart. 6540 */ 6541 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 6542 6543 /** 6544 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring 6545 * rssi threshold triggered 6546 * 6547 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6548 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type 6549 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available 6550 * @gfp: context flags 6551 * 6552 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality 6553 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform 6554 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold. 6555 */ 6556 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6557 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, 6558 s32 rssi_level, 6559 gfp_t gfp); 6560 6561 /** 6562 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss 6563 * 6564 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6565 * @gfp: context flags 6566 */ 6567 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp); 6568 6569 /** 6570 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected 6571 * 6572 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6573 */ 6574 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6575 6576 /** 6577 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process 6578 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6579 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not 6580 * 6581 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel 6582 * and wake up the suspended queues. 6583 */ 6584 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success); 6585 6586 /** 6587 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error 6588 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6589 * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame. 6590 * 6591 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel 6592 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send 6593 * a deauth frame in this case. 6594 */ 6595 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6596 bool block_tx); 6597 6598 /** 6599 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition 6600 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6601 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0 6602 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode 6603 * 6604 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed 6605 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than 6606 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth. 6607 */ 6608 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id, 6609 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode); 6610 6611 /** 6612 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start 6613 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6614 */ 6615 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6616 6617 /** 6618 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired 6619 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6620 */ 6621 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6622 6623 /** 6624 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions 6625 * 6626 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device 6627 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba 6628 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs 6629 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)." 6630 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and 6631 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation. 6632 * 6633 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6634 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid 6635 * @addr: & to bssid mac address 6636 */ 6637 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap, 6638 const u8 *addr); 6639 6640 /** 6641 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered 6642 * @pubsta: station struct 6643 * @tid: the session's TID 6644 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are 6645 * assumed to be out of the window after the call 6646 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc. 6647 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware 6648 * 6649 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and 6650 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it 6651 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released 6652 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.) 6653 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames) 6654 */ 6655 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid, 6656 u16 ssn, u64 filtered, 6657 u16 received_mpdus); 6658 6659 /** 6660 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame 6661 * 6662 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder 6663 * buffer. 6664 * 6665 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 6666 * @ra: the peer's destination address 6667 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session 6668 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver 6669 */ 6670 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn); 6671 6672 /** 6673 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work 6674 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6675 * @addr: station mac address 6676 * @tid: the rx tid 6677 */ 6678 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr, 6679 unsigned int tid); 6680 6681 /** 6682 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session 6683 * 6684 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including 6685 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx 6686 * reordering. 6687 * 6688 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here 6689 * when they complete AddBa negotiation. 6690 * 6691 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6692 * @addr: station mac address 6693 * @tid: the rx tid 6694 */ ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6695 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6696 const u8 *addr, u16 tid) 6697 { 6698 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)) 6699 return; 6700 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid); 6701 } 6702 6703 /** 6704 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session 6705 * 6706 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including 6707 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx 6708 * reordering. 6709 * 6710 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here 6711 * when they complete DelBa negotiation. 6712 * 6713 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6714 * @addr: station mac address 6715 * @tid: the rx tid 6716 */ ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)6717 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6718 const u8 *addr, u16 tid) 6719 { 6720 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)) 6721 return; 6722 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS); 6723 } 6724 6725 /** 6726 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout 6727 * 6728 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx 6729 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer. 6730 * 6731 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa. 6732 * 6733 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback 6734 * @addr: station mac address 6735 * @tid: the rx tid 6736 */ 6737 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6738 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid); 6739 6740 /* Rate control API */ 6741 6742 /** 6743 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo 6744 * 6745 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for. 6746 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on. 6747 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration 6748 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs 6749 * to be filled in 6750 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate 6751 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and 6752 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network. 6753 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the 6754 * RTS threshold 6755 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission 6756 * if the selected rate supports it 6757 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask 6758 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use) 6759 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode 6760 */ 6761 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control { 6762 struct ieee80211_hw *hw; 6763 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband; 6764 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf; 6765 struct sk_buff *skb; 6766 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate; 6767 bool rts, short_preamble; 6768 u32 rate_idx_mask; 6769 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask; 6770 bool bss; 6771 }; 6772 6773 /** 6774 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities 6775 */ 6776 enum rate_control_capabilities { 6777 /** 6778 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: 6779 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable) 6780 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains 6781 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has, 6782 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us. 6783 */ 6784 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0), 6785 /** 6786 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER: 6787 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx 6788 */ 6789 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1), 6790 }; 6791 6792 struct rate_control_ops { 6793 unsigned long capa; 6794 const char *name; 6795 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw); 6796 void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv, 6797 struct dentry *debugfsdir); 6798 void (*free)(void *priv); 6799 6800 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp); 6801 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6802 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6803 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta); 6804 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6805 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6806 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6807 u32 changed); 6808 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6809 void *priv_sta); 6810 6811 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv, 6812 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6813 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st); 6814 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6815 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6816 struct sk_buff *skb); 6817 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta, 6818 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc); 6819 6820 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta, 6821 struct dentry *dir); 6822 6823 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta); 6824 }; 6825 rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,enum nl80211_band band,int index)6826 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, 6827 enum nl80211_band band, 6828 int index) 6829 { 6830 return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index)); 6831 } 6832 6833 static inline s8 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)6834 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6835 struct ieee80211_sta *sta) 6836 { 6837 int i; 6838 6839 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++) 6840 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i)) 6841 return i; 6842 6843 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */ 6844 WARN_ON_ONCE(1); 6845 6846 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */ 6847 return 0; 6848 } 6849 6850 static inline rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)6851 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6852 struct ieee80211_sta *sta) 6853 { 6854 unsigned int i; 6855 6856 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++) 6857 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i)) 6858 return true; 6859 return false; 6860 } 6861 6862 /** 6863 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver 6864 * 6865 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass 6866 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station 6867 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on 6868 * the most recent rate control module decision. 6869 * 6870 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 6871 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination. 6872 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station. 6873 */ 6874 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 6875 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, 6876 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates); 6877 6878 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops); 6879 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops); 6880 6881 static inline bool conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6882 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6883 { 6884 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20; 6885 } 6886 6887 static inline bool conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6888 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6889 { 6890 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 && 6891 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq; 6892 } 6893 6894 static inline bool conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6895 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6896 { 6897 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 && 6898 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq; 6899 } 6900 6901 static inline bool conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6902 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6903 { 6904 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40; 6905 } 6906 6907 static inline bool conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6908 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf) 6909 { 6910 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) && 6911 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) && 6912 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT); 6913 } 6914 6915 static inline enum nl80211_iftype ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type,bool p2p)6916 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p) 6917 { 6918 if (p2p) { 6919 switch (type) { 6920 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: 6921 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT; 6922 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: 6923 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO; 6924 default: 6925 break; 6926 } 6927 } 6928 return type; 6929 } 6930 6931 static inline enum nl80211_iftype ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6932 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6933 { 6934 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p); 6935 } 6936 6937 /** 6938 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif 6939 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 6940 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from 6941 * 6942 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found 6943 */ 6944 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6945 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6946 struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6947 { 6948 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif)); 6949 } 6950 6951 /** 6952 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities 6953 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 6954 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from 6955 * 6956 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities 6957 */ 6958 static inline __le16 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6959 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6960 struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6961 { 6962 return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif)); 6963 } 6964 6965 /** 6966 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif 6967 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 6968 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from 6969 * 6970 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found 6971 */ 6972 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6973 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6974 struct ieee80211_vif *vif) 6975 { 6976 return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif)); 6977 } 6978 6979 /** 6980 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data 6981 * 6982 * @vif: the specified virtual interface 6983 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0 6984 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group 6985 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group 6986 * 6987 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and 6988 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the 6989 * matching GroupId management frame. 6990 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path. 6991 */ 6992 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id, 6993 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position); 6994 6995 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 6996 int rssi_min_thold, 6997 int rssi_max_thold); 6998 6999 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 7000 7001 /** 7002 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface 7003 * 7004 * @vif: the specified virtual interface 7005 * 7006 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid. 7007 * 7008 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not 7009 * applicable. 7010 */ 7011 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 7012 7013 /** 7014 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup 7015 * @vif: virtual interface 7016 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s) 7017 * @gfp: allocation flags 7018 * 7019 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(). 7020 */ 7021 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7022 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, 7023 gfp_t gfp); 7024 7025 /** 7026 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission 7027 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7028 * @vif: virtual interface 7029 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver 7030 * @band: the band to transmit on 7031 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to 7032 * 7033 * Note: must be called under RCU lock 7034 */ 7035 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7036 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb, 7037 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta); 7038 7039 /** 7040 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header 7041 * of injected frames. 7042 * 7043 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields, 7044 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure 7045 * of the skb before calling this function. 7046 * 7047 * @skb: packet injected by userspace 7048 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device 7049 */ 7050 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb, 7051 struct net_device *dev); 7052 7053 /** 7054 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state 7055 * 7056 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change 7057 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending 7058 * 7059 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent 7060 * 7061 * private: 7062 * 7063 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors 7064 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA 7065 */ 7066 struct ieee80211_noa_data { 7067 u32 next_tsf; 7068 bool has_next_tsf; 7069 7070 u8 absent; 7071 7072 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX]; 7073 struct { 7074 u32 start; 7075 u32 duration; 7076 u32 interval; 7077 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX]; 7078 }; 7079 7080 /** 7081 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE 7082 * 7083 * @attr: P2P NoA IE 7084 * @data: NoA tracking data 7085 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp 7086 * 7087 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors 7088 */ 7089 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr, 7090 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf); 7091 7092 /** 7093 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change 7094 * 7095 * @data: NoA tracking data 7096 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp 7097 */ 7098 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf); 7099 7100 /** 7101 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation 7102 * @vif: virtual interface 7103 * @peer: the peer's destination address 7104 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation 7105 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown 7106 * @gfp: allocation flags 7107 * 7108 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(). 7109 */ 7110 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer, 7111 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, 7112 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); 7113 7114 /** 7115 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID 7116 * 7117 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from 7118 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such 7119 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID, 7120 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks 7121 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be 7122 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC. 7123 * 7124 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it 7125 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should 7126 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback. 7127 * 7128 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for 7129 * @tid: the TID to reserve 7130 * 7131 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure 7132 */ 7133 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 7134 7135 /** 7136 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID 7137 * 7138 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function 7139 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for 7140 * preventing use of this TID in the driver. 7141 * 7142 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called 7143 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called 7144 * from the driver's @sta_state callback. 7145 * 7146 * @sta: the station 7147 * @tid: the TID to unreserve 7148 */ 7149 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid); 7150 7151 /** 7152 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue 7153 * 7154 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7155 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from 7156 * ieee80211_next_txq() 7157 * 7158 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available. 7159 * 7160 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section, 7161 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in 7162 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the 7163 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call 7164 * but for the duration of the frame handling. 7165 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method, 7166 * rcu_read_lock() is already held. 7167 * 7168 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called. 7169 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead. 7170 */ 7171 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7172 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7173 7174 /** 7175 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue 7176 * (in process context) 7177 * 7178 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context 7179 * (internally disables bottom halves). 7180 * 7181 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7182 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from 7183 * ieee80211_next_txq() 7184 */ ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7185 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7186 struct ieee80211_txq *txq) 7187 { 7188 struct sk_buff *skb; 7189 7190 local_bh_disable(); 7191 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq); 7192 local_bh_enable(); 7193 7194 return skb; 7195 } 7196 7197 /** 7198 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback 7199 * 7200 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback(). 7201 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback(). 7202 * 7203 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue 7204 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function. 7205 */ 7206 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7207 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7208 7209 /** 7210 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from 7211 * 7212 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7213 * @ac: AC number to return packets from. 7214 * 7215 * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq 7216 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the 7217 * driver has finished scheduling it. 7218 */ 7219 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac); 7220 7221 /** 7222 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs 7223 * 7224 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7225 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for 7226 * 7227 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq(). 7228 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently. 7229 */ 7230 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac); 7231 7232 /* (deprecated) */ ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u8 ac)7233 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac) 7234 { 7235 } 7236 7237 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7238 struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force); 7239 7240 /** 7241 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission 7242 * 7243 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7244 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7245 * 7246 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled, 7247 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered. 7248 * 7249 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for 7250 * this TXQ internally. 7251 */ 7252 static inline void ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7253 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq) 7254 { 7255 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true); 7256 } 7257 7258 /** 7259 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq() 7260 * 7261 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7262 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7263 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets. 7264 * 7265 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ 7266 * internally. 7267 */ 7268 static inline void ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq,bool force)7269 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq, 7270 bool force) 7271 { 7272 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force); 7273 } 7274 7275 /** 7276 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit 7277 * 7278 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by 7279 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime 7280 * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by 7281 * next_txq(). 7282 * 7283 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to 7284 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have 7285 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will 7286 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit 7287 * again. 7288 * 7289 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be 7290 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates 7291 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry 7292 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this 7293 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets 7294 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq(). 7295 * 7296 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7297 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7298 */ 7299 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7300 struct ieee80211_txq *txq); 7301 7302 /** 7303 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq 7304 * 7305 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e. 7306 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up 7307 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa. 7308 * 7309 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface 7310 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count 7311 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count 7312 */ 7313 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq, 7314 unsigned long *frame_cnt, 7315 unsigned long *byte_cnt); 7316 7317 /** 7318 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. 7319 * 7320 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination. 7321 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq. 7322 * 7323 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7324 * @inst_id: the local instance id 7325 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) 7326 * @gfp: allocation flags 7327 */ 7328 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7329 u8 inst_id, 7330 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, 7331 gfp_t gfp); 7332 7333 /** 7334 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event. 7335 * 7336 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The 7337 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211. 7338 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq. 7339 * 7340 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7341 * @match: match event information 7342 * @gfp: allocation flags 7343 */ 7344 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7345 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, 7346 gfp_t gfp); 7347 7348 /** 7349 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX. 7350 * 7351 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the 7352 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length. 7353 * 7354 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7355 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate 7356 * information. 7357 * @len: frame length in bytes 7358 */ 7359 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7360 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status, 7361 int len); 7362 7363 /** 7364 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX. 7365 * 7366 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the 7367 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length. 7368 * 7369 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw() 7370 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame. 7371 * @len: frame length in bytes 7372 */ 7373 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7374 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, 7375 int len); 7376 /** 7377 * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading. 7378 * 7379 * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3 7380 * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the 7381 * hardware or firmware. 7382 * 7383 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7384 * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off 7385 */ 7386 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable); 7387 7388 /** 7389 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template. 7390 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 7391 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7392 * 7393 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 7394 * 7395 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error. 7396 */ 7397 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7398 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 7399 7400 /** 7401 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast 7402 * probe response template. 7403 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw(). 7404 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7405 * 7406 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb. 7407 * 7408 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error. 7409 */ 7410 struct sk_buff * 7411 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, 7412 struct ieee80211_vif *vif); 7413 7414 /** 7415 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color 7416 * collision. 7417 * 7418 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback. 7419 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is 7420 * aware of. 7421 * @gfp: allocation flags 7422 */ 7423 void 7424 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7425 u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp); 7426 7427 /** 7428 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame 7429 * 7430 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with 7431 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames. 7432 * 7433 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted. 7434 */ ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff * skb)7435 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb) 7436 { 7437 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb); 7438 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data; 7439 7440 return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP || 7441 ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control); 7442 } 7443 7444 /** 7445 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode 7446 * @vif: interface to set active links on 7447 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap 7448 * 7449 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface 7450 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active), 7451 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links. 7452 * 7453 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same 7454 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get 7455 * a sequence of calls like 7456 * - change_vif_links(0x11) 7457 * - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0) 7458 * - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP) 7459 * (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down) 7460 * - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0) 7461 * - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4) 7462 * - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP) 7463 * - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4) 7464 * - change_vif_links(0x10) 7465 * 7466 * Note: This function acquires some mac80211 locks and must not 7467 * be called with any driver locks held that could cause a 7468 * lock dependency inversion. Best call it without locks. 7469 */ 7470 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links); 7471 7472 /** 7473 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links 7474 * @vif: interface to set active links on 7475 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap 7476 * 7477 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only 7478 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and 7479 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be 7480 * completed after it returns. 7481 */ 7482 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, 7483 u16 active_links); 7484 7485 #endif /* MAC80211_H */ 7486